]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Updated German translation.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
8a037dd7 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7
EZ
56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7
EZ
89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
8a037dd7 121Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
db034ac5 200@c OBSOLETE @cindex Chill
cce74817 201@cindex Modula-2
db034ac5
AC
202Support for Modula-2
203@c OBSOLETE and Chill
204is partial. For information on Modula-2, see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
205@c OBSOLETE For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 206
cce74817
JM
207@cindex Pascal
208Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211syntax.
c906108c 212
c906108c
SS
213@cindex Fortran
214@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 215it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 216underscore.
c906108c 217
c906108c
SS
218@menu
219* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
220* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
221@end menu
222
6d2ebf8b 223@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
224@unnumberedsec Free software
225
5d161b24 226@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
227General Public License
228(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
229program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
230freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
231the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
232Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
233Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
234
235Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
236you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
237from anyone else.
238
2666264b 239@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
240
241The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
242the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
243include with the free software. Many of our most important
244programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
245texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
246when an important free software package does not come with a free
247manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
248gaps today.
249
250Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
251normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
252authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
253copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
254them from the free software world.
255
256That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
257from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
258manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
259only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
260contract to make it non-free.
261
262Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
263price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
264charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
265Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
266problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
267are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
268modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
269
270The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
271free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
272commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
273accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
274
275Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
276When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
277are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
278provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
279manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
280a changed version of the program is not really available to our
281community.
282
283Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
284acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
285author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
286authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
287to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
288may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
289with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
290are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
291of the manual.
292
293However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
294content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
295media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
296obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
297manual to replace it.
298
299Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
300lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
301free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
302the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
303realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
304the free software community.
305
306If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
307the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
308license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
309don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
310will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
311option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
312what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
313try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 314is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
315
316You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
317manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
318copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
319improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
320at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
321and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
322Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
323have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
324
325The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
326published by other publishers, at
327@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
328
6d2ebf8b 329@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
330@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
331
332Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
333other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
334development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
335of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
336to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
337file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
338blow-by-blow account.
339
340Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
341
342@quotation
343@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
344or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
345omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
346@end quotation
347
348So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
349particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
350releases:
299ffc64 351Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
352Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
353Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
354Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
355Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
356Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
357John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
358Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
359and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
360
361Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
362Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
363
b37052ae
EZ
364Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
365in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
366Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
367demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
368much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 369
b37052ae 370@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
371object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
372Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
373
374David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
375the original support for encapsulated COFF.
376
96c405b3 377Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
378
379Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
380Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
381support.
382Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
383Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
384Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
385David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
386Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
387Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
388Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
389Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
390Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
391Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
392Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
393Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
394Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
395Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
396Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
397
398Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
399
400Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401libraries.
402
403Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404about several machine instruction sets.
405
406Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412command-line editing and command history.
413
7a292a7a
SS
414Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 416
5d161b24 417Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 418He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 419symbols.
c906108c
SS
420
421Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
422Super-H processors.
423
424NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
427
428Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
429
430Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
431
96a2c332 432Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
433
434Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
435watchpoints.
436
437Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
438
439Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
440
441Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 442nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
443
444The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
445support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 446(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
447compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
448John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
449Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
450information in this manual.
451
b37052ae
EZ
452DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
453Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
454
96a2c332
SS
455Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
456development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
457fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
458Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
459Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
460Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
461Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
462addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
463JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
464Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
465Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
466Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
467Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
468Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
469Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 470
e2e0bcd1
JB
471Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
472Hat.
c906108c 473
6d2ebf8b 474@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
475@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
476
477You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
478However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
479debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
480
481@iftex
482In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
483to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
484@end iftex
485
486@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
487@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
488
489One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
490processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
491quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
492definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
493session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
494then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
495same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
496@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
497procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
498
499@smallexample
500$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
501$ @b{./m4}
502@b{define(foo,0000)}
503
504@b{foo}
5050000
506@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
507
508@b{bar}
5090000
510@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
511
512@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
513@b{baz}
514@b{C-d}
515m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
520
c906108c
SS
521@smallexample
522$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
523@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
524@c FIXME... format to come out better.
525@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 526 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 527 the conditions.
5d161b24 528There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
529 for details.
530
531@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
532(@value{GDBP})
533@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
534
535@noindent
536@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
537rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
538We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
539that examples fit in this manual.
540
541@smallexample
542(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
543@end smallexample
544
545@noindent
546We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
547Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
548@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
549@code{break} command.
550
551@smallexample
552(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
553Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
554@end smallexample
555
556@noindent
557Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
558control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
559subroutine, the program runs as usual:
560
561@smallexample
562(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
563Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
564@b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566@b{foo}
5670000
568@end smallexample
569
570@noindent
571To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
572suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
573context where it stops.
574
575@smallexample
576@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
577
5d161b24 578Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
579 at builtin.c:879
580879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
581@end smallexample
582
583@noindent
584Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
585the next line of the current function.
586
587@smallexample
588(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
589882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
590 : nil,
591@end smallexample
592
593@noindent
594@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
595by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
596@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
597subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
598
599@smallexample
600(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
601set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
602 at input.c:530
603530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
604@end smallexample
605
606@noindent
607The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
608suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
609shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
610command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
611in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
612stack frame for each active subroutine.
613
614@smallexample
615(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
616#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
617 at input.c:530
5d161b24 618#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
619 at builtin.c:882
620#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
621#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
622 at macro.c:71
623#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
624#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
625@end smallexample
626
627@noindent
628We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
629times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
630falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
631
632@smallexample
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
635(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6360x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
637def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
638(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
640 : xstrdup(rq);
641(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
643@end smallexample
644
645@noindent
646The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
647@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
648and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
649(@code{print}) to see their values.
650
651@smallexample
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
653$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
654(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
655$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
656@end smallexample
657
658@noindent
659@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
660To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
661surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
662
663@smallexample
664(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
665533 xfree(rquote);
666534
667535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
668 : xstrdup (lq);
669536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
670 : xstrdup (rq);
671537
672538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
673539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
674540 @}
675541
676542 void
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
681@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
682
683@smallexample
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
687540 @}
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
689$3 = 9
690(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
691$4 = 7
692@end smallexample
693
694@noindent
695That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
696@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
697@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
698the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
699any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
700assignments.
701
702@smallexample
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
704$5 = 7
705(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
706$6 = 9
707@end smallexample
708
709@noindent
710Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
711@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
712executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
713example that caused trouble initially:
714
715@smallexample
716(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
717Continuing.
718
719@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
720
721baz
7220000
723@end smallexample
724
725@noindent
726Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
727problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
728lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
729
730@smallexample
731@b{C-d}
732Program exited normally.
733@end smallexample
734
735@noindent
736The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
737indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
738session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
739
740@smallexample
741(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
742@end smallexample
c906108c 743
6d2ebf8b 744@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
745@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
746
747This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 748The essentials are:
c906108c 749@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 750@item
53a5351d 751type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 752@item
c906108c
SS
753type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
754@end itemize
755
756@menu
757* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
758* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
759* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
760@end menu
761
6d2ebf8b 762@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
763@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
764
c906108c
SS
765Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
766@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
767
768You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
769to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
770
c906108c
SS
771The command-line options described here are designed
772to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 773options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
774
775The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
776specifying an executable program:
777
474c8240 778@smallexample
c906108c 779@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 780@end smallexample
c906108c 781
c906108c
SS
782@noindent
783You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
784specified:
785
474c8240 786@smallexample
c906108c 787@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 788@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
789
790You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
791to debug a running process:
792
474c8240 793@smallexample
c906108c 794@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 795@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
796
797@noindent
798would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
799named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
800
c906108c 801Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
802complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
803debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
804``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
805will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 806
aa26fa3a
TT
807You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
808executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
809option processing.
474c8240 810@smallexample
aa26fa3a 811gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 812@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
813This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
814@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
815
96a2c332 816You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
817@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
818
819@smallexample
820@value{GDBP} -silent
821@end smallexample
822
823@noindent
824You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
825options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
826
827@noindent
828Type
829
474c8240 830@smallexample
c906108c 831@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 832@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
833
834@noindent
835to display all available options and briefly describe their use
836(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
837
838All options and command line arguments you give are processed
839in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
840@samp{-x} option is used.
841
842
843@menu
c906108c
SS
844* File Options:: Choosing files
845* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
846@end menu
847
6d2ebf8b 848@node File Options
c906108c
SS
849@subsection Choosing files
850
2df3850c 851When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
852specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
853the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
854@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
855first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
856equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
857second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
858equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
859If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
860first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
861to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
862a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 863prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
864
865If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
866such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
867argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
868
869Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
870following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
871them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
872(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
873than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
874
d700128c
EZ
875@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
876@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
877@c it.
878
c906108c
SS
879@table @code
880@item -symbols @var{file}
881@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
882@cindex @code{--symbols}
883@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
884Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
885
886@item -exec @var{file}
887@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
888@cindex @code{--exec}
889@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
890Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
891and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
892
893@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 894@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
895Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
896file.
897
c906108c
SS
898@item -core @var{file}
899@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--core}
901@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 902Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
903
904@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
905@item -pid @var{number}
906@itemx -p @var{number}
907@cindex @code{--pid}
908@cindex @code{-p}
909Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
910If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
911file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
912
913@item -command @var{file}
914@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
915@cindex @code{--command}
916@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
917Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
918Files,, Command files}.
919
920@item -directory @var{directory}
921@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
922@cindex @code{--directory}
923@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
924Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
925
c906108c
SS
926@item -m
927@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
928@cindex @code{--mapped}
929@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
930@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
931supported on all systems.}@*
932If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 933system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
934to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
935program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 936called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
937Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
938and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
939the symbol table from the executable program.
940
941The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
942is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
943table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 944
c906108c
SS
945@item -r
946@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
947@cindex @code{--readnow}
948@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
949Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
950the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
951This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 952
c906108c
SS
953@end table
954
2df3850c 955You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 956order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
957information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
958on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
959but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 960
474c8240 961@smallexample
2df3850c 962gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 963@end smallexample
c906108c 964
6d2ebf8b 965@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
966@subsection Choosing modes
967
968You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
969batch mode or quiet mode.
970
971@table @code
972@item -nx
973@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
974@cindex @code{--nx}
975@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 976Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
977@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
978options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
979files}.
c906108c
SS
980
981@item -quiet
d700128c 982@itemx -silent
c906108c 983@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
984@cindex @code{--quiet}
985@cindex @code{--silent}
986@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
987``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
988messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
989
990@item -batch
d700128c 991@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
992Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
993command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
994initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
995nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
996in the command files.
997
2df3850c
JM
998Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
999example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1000make this more useful, the message
c906108c 1001
474c8240 1002@smallexample
c906108c 1003Program exited normally.
474c8240 1004@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1005
1006@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1007(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1008@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1009mode.
1010
1011@item -nowindows
1012@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1013@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1014@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1015``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1016(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1017interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1018
1019@item -windows
1020@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1021@cindex @code{--windows}
1022@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1023If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1024used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1025
1026@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1027@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1028Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1029instead of the current directory.
1030
c906108c
SS
1031@item -fullname
1032@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1033@cindex @code{--fullname}
1034@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1035@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1036subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1037number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1038displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1039recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1040the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1041and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1042@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1043frame.
c906108c 1044
d700128c
EZ
1045@item -epoch
1046@cindex @code{--epoch}
1047The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1048@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1049routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1050separate window.
1051
1052@item -annotate @var{level}
1053@cindex @code{--annotate}
1054This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1055effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1056(@pxref{Annotations}).
1057Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1058together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1059types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1060@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1061maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1062
1063@item -async
1064@cindex @code{--async}
1065Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1066@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1067special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1068commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1069run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1070MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1071suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1072control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1073(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1074operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1075yet.)
1076@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1077@c should be removed.
1078
1079When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1080uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1081@samp{-noasync} option.
1082
1083@item -noasync
1084@cindex @code{--noasync}
1085Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1086
aa26fa3a
TT
1087@item --args
1088@cindex @code{--args}
1089Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1090executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1091This option stops option processing.
1092
2df3850c
JM
1093@item -baud @var{bps}
1094@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1095@cindex @code{--baud}
1096@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1097Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1098interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1099
1100@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1101@itemx -t @var{device}
1102@cindex @code{--tty}
1103@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1104Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1105@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1106
53a5351d 1107@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1108@item -tui
1109@cindex @code{--tui}
1110Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1111The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1112showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1113(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1114Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1115(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1116
1117@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1118@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1119@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1120@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1121@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1122@c systems.
1123
d700128c
EZ
1124@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1125@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1126Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1127program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1128communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1129
1130@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1131@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1132@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1133@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
d4f3574e 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3469@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3470@item stepi
96a2c332 3471@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3472@itemx si
3473Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482@need 750
3483@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3484@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3485@item nexti
96a2c332 3486@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3487@itemx ni
3488Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492@end table
3493
6d2ebf8b 3494@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3495@section Signals
3496@cindex signals
3497
3498A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3501signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3502@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505requested an alarm).
3506
3507@cindex fatal signals
3508Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3510errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3511program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517signal.
3518
3519@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3520Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3523but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526@table @code
3527@kindex info signals
3528@item info signals
96a2c332 3529@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3530Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532the defined types of signals.
3533
d4f3574e 3534@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3535
3536@kindex handle
3537@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3538Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3540@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3541@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3543@end table
3544
3545@c @group
3546The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547Their full names are:
3548
3549@table @code
3550@item nostop
3551@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554@item stop
3555@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558@item print
3559@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561@item noprint
3562@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565@item pass
5ece1a18 3566@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3567@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3569and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@item nopass
5ece1a18 3572@itemx ignore
c906108c 3573@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3574@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3575@end table
3576@c @end group
3577
d4f3574e
SS
3578When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579program until you
c906108c
SS
3580continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
24f93129
EZ
3586The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589erroneous signals.
3590
c906108c
SS
3591You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3599program a signal}.
c906108c 3600
6d2ebf8b 3601@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3602@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608@table @code
3609@cindex breakpoints and threads
3610@cindex thread breakpoints
3611@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625program.
3626
3627You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631@smallexample
2df3850c 3632(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3633@end smallexample
3634
3635@end table
3636
3637@cindex stopped threads
3638@cindex threads, stopped
3639Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643underfoot.
3644
3645@cindex continuing threads
3646@cindex threads, continuing
3647Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3649like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3650
3651In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657stops.
3658
3659You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665thread to run.
3666
3667@table @code
3668@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3675when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3676function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3677like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3678thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3679@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681@item show scheduler-locking
3682Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683@end table
3684
c906108c 3685
6d2ebf8b 3686@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3687@chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3693Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694is generated.
3695That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3697and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3698The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3699The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700stack}.
3701
3702When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705@cindex selected frame
3706One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3714currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3715@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717@menu
3718* Frames:: Stack frames
3719* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3722
3723@end menu
3724
6d2ebf8b 3725@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3726@section Stack frames
3727
d4f3574e 3728@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3729@cindex stack frame
3730The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734which the function is executing.
3735
3736@cindex initial frame
3737@cindex outermost frame
3738@cindex innermost frame
3739When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748@cindex frame pointer
3749Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754going on in that frame.
3755
3756@cindex frame number
3757@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
6d2ebf8b
SS
3763@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3765@cindex frameless execution
3766Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3767without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3768@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3769@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3770@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3771generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3772This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780@table @code
d4f3574e 3781@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3782@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3783@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3784The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3785and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3786address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3788
3789@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3790@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3791@item select-frame
3792The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794@code{frame}.
3795@end table
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3798@section Backtraces
3799
3800@cindex backtraces
3801@cindex tracebacks
3802@cindex stack traces
3803A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806stack.
3807
3808@table @code
3809@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3810@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3811@item backtrace
3812@itemx bt
3813Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814frames in the stack.
3815
3816You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819@item backtrace @var{n}
3820@itemx bt @var{n}
3821Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823@item backtrace -@var{n}
3824@itemx bt -@var{n}
3825Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826@end table
3827
3828@kindex where
3829@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3830@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3831The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839line number.
3840
3841Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844@smallexample
3845@group
5d161b24 3846#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851(More stack frames follow...)
3852@end group
3853@end smallexample
3854
3855@noindent
3856The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
6d2ebf8b 3860@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3861@section Selecting a frame
3862
3863Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3864whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3865selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3866of the stack frame just selected.
3867
3868@table @code
d4f3574e 3869@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3870@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3871@item frame @var{n}
3872@itemx f @var{n}
3873Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3874(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3875innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3876@code{main}.
3877
3878@item frame @var{addr}
3879@itemx f @var{addr}
3880Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3881chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3882impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3883addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3884switches between them.
3885
c906108c
SS
3886On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3887select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3888
3889On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3890pointer and a program counter.
3891
3892On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3893pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3894@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3895@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3896@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3897
3898@kindex up
3899@item up @var{n}
3900Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3901advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3902that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3903
3904@kindex down
41afff9a 3905@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3906@item down @var{n}
3907Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3908advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3909that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3910abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3911@end table
3912
3913All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3914frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3915arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3916frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3917
3918@need 1000
3919For example:
3920
3921@smallexample
3922@group
3923(@value{GDBP}) up
3924#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3925 at env.c:10
392610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3927@end group
3928@end smallexample
3929
3930After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3931prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3932You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3933editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3934@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3935for details.
c906108c
SS
3936
3937@table @code
3938@kindex down-silently
3939@kindex up-silently
3940@item up-silently @var{n}
3941@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3942These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3943respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3944causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3945in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3946distracting.
3947@end table
3948
6d2ebf8b 3949@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3950@section Information about a frame
3951
3952There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3953stack frame.
3954
3955@table @code
3956@item frame
3957@itemx f
3958When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3959frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3960selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3961argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3962@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3963
3964@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3965@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3966@item info frame
3967@itemx info f
3968This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3969including:
3970
3971@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3972@item
3973the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3974@item
3975the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3976@item
3977the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3978@item
3979the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3980@item
3981the address of the frame's arguments
3982@item
d4f3574e
SS
3983the address of the frame's local variables
3984@item
c906108c
SS
3985the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3986@item
3987which registers were saved in the frame
3988@end itemize
3989
3990@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3991something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3992the usual conventions.
3993
3994@item info frame @var{addr}
3995@itemx info f @var{addr}
3996Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3997selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3998command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3999architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4000@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4001
4002@kindex info args
4003@item info args
4004Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4005
4006@item info locals
4007@kindex info locals
4008Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4009line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4010accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4011
c906108c 4012@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4013@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4014@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4015@item info catch
4016Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4017current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4018exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4019@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4020@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4021
c906108c
SS
4022@end table
4023
c906108c 4024
6d2ebf8b 4025@node Source
c906108c
SS
4026@chapter Examining Source Files
4027
4028@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4029information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4030used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4031the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4032(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4033execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4034source files by explicit command.
4035
7a292a7a 4036If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4037prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4038@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4039
4040@menu
4041* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4042* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4043* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4044* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4045* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4046@end menu
4047
6d2ebf8b 4048@node List
c906108c
SS
4049@section Printing source lines
4050
4051@kindex list
41afff9a 4052@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4053To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4054(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4055There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4056
4057Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4058
4059@table @code
4060@item list @var{linenum}
4061Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4062current source file.
4063
4064@item list @var{function}
4065Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4066@var{function}.
4067
4068@item list
4069Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4070@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4071printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4072as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4073Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4074
4075@item list -
4076Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4077@end table
4078
4079By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4080the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4081
4082@table @code
4083@kindex set listsize
4084@item set listsize @var{count}
4085Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4086the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4087
4088@kindex show listsize
4089@item show listsize
4090Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4091@end table
4092
4093Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4094so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4095than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4096argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4097each repetition moves up in the source file.
4098
4099@cindex linespec
4100In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4101@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4102of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4103Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4104
4105@table @code
4106@item list @var{linespec}
4107Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4108
4109@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4110Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4111linespecs.
4112
4113@item list ,@var{last}
4114Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4115
4116@item list @var{first},
4117Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4118
4119@item list +
4120Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4121
4122@item list -
4123Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4124
4125@item list
4126As described in the preceding table.
4127@end table
4128
4129Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4130kinds of linespec.
4131
4132@table @code
4133@item @var{number}
4134Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4135When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4136the same source file as the first linespec.
4137
4138@item +@var{offset}
4139Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4140When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4141two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4142first linespec.
4143
4144@item -@var{offset}
4145Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4146
4147@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4148Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4149
4150@item @var{function}
4151Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4152For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4153
4154@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4155Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4156function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4157file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4158identically named functions in different source files.
4159
4160@item *@var{address}
4161Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4162@var{address} may be any expression.
4163@end table
4164
87885426
FN
4165@node Edit
4166@section Editing source files
4167@cindex editing source files
4168
4169@kindex edit
4170@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4171To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4172The editing program of your choice
4173is invoked with the current line set to
4174the active line in the program.
4175Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4176want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4177
4178Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4179
4180@table @code
4181@item edit
4182Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4183
4184@item edit @var{number}
4185Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4186
4187@item edit @var{function}
4188Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4189
4190@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4191Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4192
4193@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4194Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4195function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4196file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4197identically named functions in different source files.
4198
4199@item edit *@var{address}
4200Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4201@var{address} may be any expression.
4202@end table
4203
4204@subsection Choosing your editor
4205You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4206@footnote{
4207The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4208following command-line syntax:
4209@example
4210ex +@var{number} file
4211@end example
4212The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in the file.
4213}.
4214By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this by setting the
4215environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4216@value{GDBN}.
4217For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the @code{vi} editor, you
4218could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4219@example
4220EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4221export EDITOR
4222gdb ...
4223@end example
4224or in the @code{csh} shell,
4225@example
4226setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4227gdb ...
4228@end example
4229
6d2ebf8b 4230@node Search
c906108c
SS
4231@section Searching source files
4232@cindex searching
4233@kindex reverse-search
4234
4235There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4236regular expression.
4237
4238@table @code
4239@kindex search
4240@kindex forward-search
4241@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4242@itemx search @var{regexp}
4243The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4244starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4245@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4246synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4247@code{fo}.
4248
4249@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4250The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4251with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4252for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4253this command as @code{rev}.
4254@end table
c906108c 4255
6d2ebf8b 4256@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4257@section Specifying source directories
4258
4259@cindex source path
4260@cindex directories for source files
4261Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4262files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4263the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4264session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4265this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4266it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4267in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4268the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4269the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4270path.
4271
4272If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4273object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4274too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4275compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4276last resort.
4277
4278Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4279any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4280each line is in the file.
4281
4282@kindex directory
4283@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4284When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4285and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4286To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4287
4288@table @code
4289@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4290@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4291Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4292directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4293(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4294part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4295whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4296path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4297
4298@kindex cdir
4299@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4300@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4301@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4302@cindex compilation directory
4303@cindex current directory
4304@cindex working directory
4305@cindex directory, current
4306@cindex directory, compilation
4307You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4308directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4309working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4310tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4311session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4312directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4313
4314@item directory
4315Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4316
4317@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4318@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4319
4320@item show directories
4321@kindex show directories
4322Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4323@end table
4324
4325If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4326interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4327versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4328
4329@enumerate
4330@item
4331Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4332
4333@item
4334Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4335directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4336directories in one command.
4337@end enumerate
4338
6d2ebf8b 4339@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4340@section Source and machine code
4341
4342You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4343addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4344a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4345mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4346line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4347well as hex.
4348
4349@table @code
4350@kindex info line
4351@item info line @var{linespec}
4352Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4353source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4354the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4355source lines}).
4356@end table
4357
4358For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4359the object code for the first line of function
4360@code{m4_changequote}:
4361
d4f3574e
SS
4362@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4363@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4364@smallexample
96a2c332 4365(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4366Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4367@end smallexample
4368
4369@noindent
4370We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4371@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4372@smallexample
4373(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4374Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4375@end smallexample
4376
4377@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4378@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4379After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4380is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4381sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4382,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4383convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4384variables}).
4385
4386@table @code
4387@kindex disassemble
4388@cindex assembly instructions
4389@cindex instructions, assembly
4390@cindex machine instructions
4391@cindex listing machine instructions
4392@item disassemble
4393This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4394instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4395program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4396command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4397surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4398(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4399@end table
4400
c906108c
SS
4401The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4402HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4403
4404@smallexample
4405(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4406Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44070x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44080x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44090x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44100x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44110x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44120x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44130x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44140x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4415End of assembler dump.
4416@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4417
4418Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4419mnemonics or other syntax.
4420
4421@table @code
d4f3574e 4422@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4423@cindex assembly instructions
4424@cindex instructions, assembly
4425@cindex machine instructions
4426@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4427@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4428@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4429@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4430Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4431program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4432
4433Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4434can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4435The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4436assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4437@end table
4438
4439
6d2ebf8b 4440@node Data
c906108c
SS
4441@chapter Examining Data
4442
4443@cindex printing data
4444@cindex examining data
4445@kindex print
4446@kindex inspect
4447@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4448@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4449@c different window or something like that.
4450The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4451command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4452evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4453program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4454Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4455
4456@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4457@item print @var{expr}
4458@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4459@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4460value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4461you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4462@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4463formats}.
4464
4465@item print
4466@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4467If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4468@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4469conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4470@end table
4471
4472A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4473It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4474specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4475
7a292a7a 4476If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4477fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4478command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4479Table}.
c906108c
SS
4480
4481@menu
4482* Expressions:: Expressions
4483* Variables:: Program variables
4484* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4485* Output Formats:: Output formats
4486* Memory:: Examining memory
4487* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4488* Print Settings:: Print settings
4489* Value History:: Value history
4490* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4491* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4492* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4493* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4494* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4495* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4496* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4497 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4498@end menu
4499
6d2ebf8b 4500@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4501@section Expressions
4502
4503@cindex expressions
4504@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4505compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4506by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4507@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4508casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4509you compiled your program to include this information; see
4510@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4511
d4f3574e
SS
4512@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4513the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4514you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4515memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4516
c906108c
SS
4517Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4518this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4519Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4520languages.
4521
4522In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4523expressions regardless of your programming language.
4524
4525Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4526useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4527at that address in memory.
4528@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4529
4530@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4531to programming languages:
4532
4533@table @code
4534@item @@
4535@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4536@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4537
4538@item ::
4539@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4540function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4541
4542@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4543@cindex type casting memory
4544@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4545@cindex casts, to view memory
4546@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4547Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4548memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4549pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4550a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4551normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4552@end table
4553
6d2ebf8b 4554@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4555@section Program variables
4556
4557The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4558in your program.
4559
4560Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4561(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4562
4563@itemize @bullet
4564@item
4565global (or file-static)
4566@end itemize
4567
5d161b24 4568@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4569
4570@itemize @bullet
4571@item
4572visible according to the scope rules of the
4573programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4574@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4575
4576@noindent This means that in the function
4577
474c8240 4578@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4579foo (a)
4580 int a;
4581@{
4582 bar (a);
4583 @{
4584 int b = test ();
4585 bar (b);
4586 @}
4587@}
474c8240 4588@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4589
4590@noindent
4591you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4592executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4593examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4594the block where @code{b} is declared.
4595
4596@cindex variable name conflict
4597There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4598scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4599in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4600function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4601happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4602you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4603using the colon-colon notation:
4604
d4f3574e 4605@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4606@iftex
4607@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4608@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4609@end iftex
474c8240 4610@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4611@var{file}::@var{variable}
4612@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4613@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4614
4615@noindent
4616Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4617static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4618make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4619to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4620
474c8240 4621@smallexample
c906108c 4622(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4623@end smallexample
c906108c 4624
b37052ae 4625@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4626This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4627use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4628scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4629@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4630@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4631
4632@cindex wrong values
4633@cindex variable values, wrong
4634@quotation
4635@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4636wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4637scope, and just before exit.
4638@end quotation
4639You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4640This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4641set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4642stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4643values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4644also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4645after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4646variable definitions may be gone.
4647
4648This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4649To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4650when compiling.
4651
d4f3574e
SS
4652@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4653Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4654unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4655opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4656offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4657might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4658happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4659
474c8240 4660@smallexample
d4f3574e 4661No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4662@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4663
4664To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4665different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4666formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4667supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4668in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4669to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4670debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4671Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4672information.
4673
4674
6d2ebf8b 4675@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4676@section Artificial arrays
4677
4678@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4679@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4680It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4681same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4682dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4683program.
4684
4685You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4686@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4687operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4688and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4689of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4690the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4691argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4692following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4693example. If a program says
4694
474c8240 4695@smallexample
c906108c 4696int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4697@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4698
4699@noindent
4700you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4701
474c8240 4702@smallexample
c906108c 4703p *array@@len
474c8240 4704@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4705
4706The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4707with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4708subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4709Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4710(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4711
4712Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4713This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4714The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4715@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4716(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4717$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4718@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4719
4720As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4721@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4722the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4723@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4724(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4725$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4726@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4727
4728Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4729moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4730actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4731of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4732to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4733variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4734interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4735instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4736structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4737in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4738
474c8240 4739@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4740set $i = 0
4741p dtab[$i++]->fv
4742@key{RET}
4743@key{RET}
4744@dots{}
474c8240 4745@end smallexample
c906108c 4746
6d2ebf8b 4747@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4748@section Output formats
4749
4750@cindex formatted output
4751@cindex output formats
4752By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4753this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4754in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4755at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4756these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4757
4758The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4759already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4760@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4761letters supported are:
4762
4763@table @code
4764@item x
4765Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4766hexadecimal.
4767
4768@item d
4769Print as integer in signed decimal.
4770
4771@item u
4772Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4773
4774@item o
4775Print as integer in octal.
4776
4777@item t
4778Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4779@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4780used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4781see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4782
4783@item a
4784@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4785@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4786Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4787the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4788where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4789
474c8240 4790@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4791(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4792$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4793@end smallexample
c906108c 4794
3d67e040
EZ
4795@noindent
4796The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4797@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4798
c906108c
SS
4799@item c
4800Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4801
4802@item f
4803Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4804using typical floating point syntax.
4805@end table
4806
4807For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4808
474c8240 4809@smallexample
c906108c 4810p/x $pc
474c8240 4811@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4812
4813@noindent
4814Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4815names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4816
4817To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4818you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4819expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4820
6d2ebf8b 4821@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4822@section Examining memory
4823
4824You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4825any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4826
4827@cindex examining memory
4828@table @code
41afff9a 4829@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4830@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4831@itemx x @var{addr}
4832@itemx x
4833Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4834@end table
4835
4836@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4837much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4838expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4839If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4840Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4841
4842@table @r
4843@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4844The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4845how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4846@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4847@c 4.1.2.
4848
4849@item @var{f}, the display format
4850The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4851@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4852The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4853The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4854
4855@item @var{u}, the unit size
4856The unit size is any of
4857
4858@table @code
4859@item b
4860Bytes.
4861@item h
4862Halfwords (two bytes).
4863@item w
4864Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4865@item g
4866Giant words (eight bytes).
4867@end table
4868
4869Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4870default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4871@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4872
4873@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4874@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4875memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4876it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4877@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4878@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4879other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4880the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4881starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4882a value from memory).
4883@end table
4884
4885For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4886(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4887starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4888words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4889@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4890
4891Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4892letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4893unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4894specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4895(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4896
4897Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4898and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4899@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4900including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4901alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4902Code,,Source and machine code}.
4903
4904All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4905easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4906you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4907instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4908with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4909the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4910for successive uses of @code{x}.
4911
4912@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4913The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4914in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4915would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4916subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4917@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4918examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4919@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4920the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4921
4922If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4923are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4924address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4925
6d2ebf8b 4926@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4927@section Automatic display
4928@cindex automatic display
4929@cindex display of expressions
4930
4931If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4932(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4933display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4934Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4935to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4936The automatic display looks like this:
4937
474c8240 4938@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49392: foo = 38
49403: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4941@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4942
4943@noindent
4944This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4945displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4946specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4947whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4948format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4949or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4950supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4951
4952@table @code
4953@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4954@item display @var{expr}
4955Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4956each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4957
4958@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4959
d4f3574e 4960@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4961For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4962count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4963arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4964@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4965
4966@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4967For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4968number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4969be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4970doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4971@end table
4972
4973For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4974instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4975is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4976
4977@table @code
4978@kindex delete display
4979@kindex undisplay
4980@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4981@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4982Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4983
4984@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4985(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4986
4987@kindex disable display
4988@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4989Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4990item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4991enabled again later.
4992
4993@kindex enable display
4994@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4995Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4996again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4997
4998@item display
4999Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5000done when your program stops.
5001
5002@kindex info display
5003@item info display
5004Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5005automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5006values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5007It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5008because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5009@end table
5010
5011If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5012sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5013expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5014variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5015@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5016@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5017continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5018there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5019automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5020is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5021
6d2ebf8b 5022@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5023@section Print settings
5024
5025@cindex format options
5026@cindex print settings
5027@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5028and symbols are printed.
5029
5030@noindent
5031These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5032
5033@table @code
5034@kindex set print address
5035@item set print address
5036@itemx set print address on
5037@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5038traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5039even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5040is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5041@code{set print address on}:
5042
5043@smallexample
5044@group
5045(@value{GDBP}) f
5046#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5047 at input.c:530
5048530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5049@end group
5050@end smallexample
5051
5052@item set print address off
5053Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5054this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5055
5056@smallexample
5057@group
5058(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5059(@value{GDBP}) f
5060#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5061530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5062@end group
5063@end smallexample
5064
5065You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5066dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5067@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5068all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5069
5070@kindex show print address
5071@item show print address
5072Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5073@end table
5074
5075When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5076closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5077identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5078source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5079@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5080you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5081it prints a symbolic address:
5082
5083@table @code
5084@kindex set print symbol-filename
5085@item set print symbol-filename on
5086Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5087symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5088
5089@item set print symbol-filename off
5090Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5091default.
5092
5093@kindex show print symbol-filename
5094@item show print symbol-filename
5095Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5096line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5097@end table
5098
5099Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5100numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5101number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5102
5103Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5104printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5105
5106@table @code
5107@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5108@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5109Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5110offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5111@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5112to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5113
5114@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5115@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5116Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5117symbolic address.
5118@end table
5119
5120@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5121@cindex pointer, finding referent
5122If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5123@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5124and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5125@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5126For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5127at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5128
474c8240 5129@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5130(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5131(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5132$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5133@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5134
5135@quotation
5136@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5137does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5138the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5139@end quotation
5140
5141Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5142
5143@table @code
5144@kindex set print array
5145@item set print array
5146@itemx set print array on
5147Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5148but uses more space. The default is off.
5149
5150@item set print array off
5151Return to compressed format for arrays.
5152
5153@kindex show print array
5154@item show print array
5155Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5156arrays.
5157
5158@kindex set print elements
5159@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5160Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5161If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5162printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5163This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5164When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5165Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5166
5167@kindex show print elements
5168@item show print elements
5169Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5170If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5171
5172@kindex set print null-stop
5173@item set print null-stop
5174Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5175@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5176contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5177The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5178
5179@kindex set print pretty
5180@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5181Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5182per line, like this:
5183
5184@smallexample
5185@group
5186$1 = @{
5187 next = 0x0,
5188 flags = @{
5189 sweet = 1,
5190 sour = 1
5191 @},
5192 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5193@}
5194@end group
5195@end smallexample
5196
5197@item set print pretty off
5198Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5199
5200@smallexample
5201@group
5202$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5203meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5204@end group
5205@end smallexample
5206
5207@noindent
5208This is the default format.
5209
5210@kindex show print pretty
5211@item show print pretty
5212Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5213
5214@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5215@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5216Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5217@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5218character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5219best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5220high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5221
5222@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5223Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5224international character sets, and is the default.
5225
5226@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5227@item show print sevenbit-strings
5228Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5229
5230@kindex set print union
5231@item set print union on
5d161b24 5232Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5233is the default setting.
5234
5235@item set print union off
5236Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5237
5238@kindex show print union
5239@item show print union
5240Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5241structures.
5242
5243For example, given the declarations
5244
5245@smallexample
5246typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5247typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5248typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5249 Bug_forms;
5250
5251struct thing @{
5252 Species it;
5253 union @{
5254 Tree_forms tree;
5255 Bug_forms bug;
5256 @} form;
5257@};
5258
5259struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5260@end smallexample
5261
5262@noindent
5263with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5264
5265@smallexample
5266$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5267@end smallexample
5268
5269@noindent
5270and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5271
5272@smallexample
5273$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5274@end smallexample
5275@end table
5276
c906108c
SS
5277@need 1000
5278@noindent
b37052ae 5279These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5280
5281@table @code
5282@cindex demangling
5283@kindex set print demangle
5284@item set print demangle
5285@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5286Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5287(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5288linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5289
5290@kindex show print demangle
5291@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5292Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5293
5294@kindex set print asm-demangle
5295@item set print asm-demangle
5296@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5297Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5298in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5299The default is off.
5300
5301@kindex show print asm-demangle
5302@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5303Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5304or demangled form.
5305
5306@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5307@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5308@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5309@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5310Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5311represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5312
5313@table @code
5314@item auto
5315Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5316
5317@item gnu
b37052ae 5318Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5319This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5320
5321@item hp
b37052ae 5322Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5323
5324@item lucid
b37052ae 5325Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5326
5327@item arm
b37052ae 5328Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5329@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5330debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5331require further enhancement to permit that.
5332
5333@end table
5334If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5335
5336@kindex show demangle-style
5337@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5338Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5339
5340@kindex set print object
5341@item set print object
5342@itemx set print object on
5343When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5344(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5345the virtual function table.
5346
5347@item set print object off
5348Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5349virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5350
5351@kindex show print object
5352@item show print object
5353Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5354
5355@kindex set print static-members
5356@item set print static-members
5357@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5358Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5359
5360@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5361Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5362
5363@kindex show print static-members
5364@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5365Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5366
5367@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5368@kindex set print vtbl
5369@item set print vtbl
5370@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5371Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5372(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5373ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5374
5375@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5376Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5377
5378@kindex show print vtbl
5379@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5380Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5381@end table
c906108c 5382
6d2ebf8b 5383@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5384@section Value history
5385
5386@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5387Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5388@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5389Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5390(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5391When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5392since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5393symbol table.
5394
5395@cindex @code{$}
5396@cindex @code{$$}
5397@cindex history number
5398The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5399refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5400@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5401printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5402history number.
5403
5404To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5405history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5406remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5407the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5408@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5409is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5410@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5411
5412For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5413want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5414
474c8240 5415@smallexample
c906108c 5416p *$
474c8240 5417@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5418
5419If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5420to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5421
474c8240 5422@smallexample
c906108c 5423p *$.next
474c8240 5424@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5425
5426@noindent
5427You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5428command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5429
5430Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5431@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5432
474c8240 5433@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5434print x
5435set x=5
474c8240 5436@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5437
5438@noindent
5439then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5440remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5441
5442@table @code
5443@kindex show values
5444@item show values
5445Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5446This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5447values} does not change the history.
5448
5449@item show values @var{n}
5450Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5451
5452@item show values +
5453Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5454values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5455@end table
5456
5457Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5458same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5459
6d2ebf8b 5460@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5461@section Convenience variables
5462
5463@cindex convenience variables
5464@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5465@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5466exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5467setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5468of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5469
5470Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5471@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5472the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5473(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5474by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5475
5476You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5477expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5478For example:
5479
474c8240 5480@smallexample
c906108c 5481set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5482@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5483
5484@noindent
5485would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5486@code{object_ptr}.
5487
5488Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5489value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5490value with another assignment at any time.
5491
5492Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5493variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5494that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5495variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5496
5497@table @code
5498@kindex show convenience
5499@item show convenience
5500Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5501Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5502@end table
5503
5504One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5505incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5506a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5507
474c8240 5508@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5509set $i = 0
5510print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5511@end smallexample
c906108c 5512
d4f3574e
SS
5513@noindent
5514Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5515
5516Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5517values likely to be useful.
5518
5519@table @code
41afff9a 5520@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5521@item $_
5522The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5523the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5524commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5525set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5526and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5527except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5528to the type of @code{$__}.
5529
41afff9a 5530@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5531@item $__
5532The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5533to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5534to match the format in which the data was printed.
5535
5536@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5537@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5538The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5539the program being debugged terminates.
5540@end table
5541
53a5351d
JM
5542On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5543begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5544name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5545
6d2ebf8b 5546@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5547@section Registers
5548
5549@cindex registers
5550You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5551with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5552for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5553your machine.
5554
5555@table @code
5556@kindex info registers
5557@item info registers
5558Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5559registers (in the selected stack frame).
5560
5561@kindex info all-registers
5562@cindex floating point registers
5563@item info all-registers
5564Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5565registers.
5566
5567@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5568Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5569As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5570the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5571the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5572@end table
5573
5574@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5575expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5576architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5577@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5578the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5579pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5580register that contains the processor status. For example,
5581you could print the program counter in hex with
5582
474c8240 5583@smallexample
c906108c 5584p/x $pc
474c8240 5585@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5586
5587@noindent
5588or print the instruction to be executed next with
5589
474c8240 5590@smallexample
c906108c 5591x/i $pc
474c8240 5592@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5593
5594@noindent
5595or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5596one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5597memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5598stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5599stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5600regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5601see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5602
474c8240 5603@smallexample
c906108c 5604set $sp += 4
474c8240 5605@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5606
5607Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5608your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5609so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5610shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5611registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5612can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5613is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5614
5615@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5616integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5617special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5618registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5619to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5620(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5621@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5622
5623Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5624means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5625the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5626sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5627coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5628programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5629cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5630that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5631prints the data in both formats.
5632
5633Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5634(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5635value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5636were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5637true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5638frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5639
5640However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5641code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5642@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5643frame makes no difference.
5644
6d2ebf8b 5645@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5646@section Floating point hardware
5647@cindex floating point
5648
5649Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5650you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5651
5652@table @code
5653@kindex info float
5654@item info float
5655Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5656point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5657floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5658the ARM and x86 machines.
5659@end table
c906108c 5660
e76f1f2e
AC
5661@node Vector Unit
5662@section Vector Unit
5663@cindex vector unit
5664
5665Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5666more information about the status of the vector unit.
5667
5668@table @code
5669@kindex info vector
5670@item info vector
5671Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5672layout vary depending on the hardware.
5673@end table
5674
29e57380 5675@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5676@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5677@cindex memory region attributes
5678
5679@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5680required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5681to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5682use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5683
5684Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5685memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5686accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5687been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5688all memory.
5689
5690When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5691to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5692
5693@table @code
5694@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5695@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5696Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5697attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5698special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5699(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5700
5701@kindex delete mem
5702@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5703Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5704
5705@kindex disable mem
5706@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5707Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5708A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5709It may be enabled again later.
5710
5711@kindex enable mem
5712@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5713Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5714
5715@kindex info mem
5716@item info mem
5717Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5718for each region.
5719
5720@table @emph
5721@item Memory Region Number
5722@item Enabled or Disabled.
5723Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5724Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5725
5726@item Lo Address
5727The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5728
5729@item Hi Address
5730The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5731
5732@item Attributes
5733The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5734@end table
5735@end table
5736
5737
5738@subsection Attributes
5739
5740@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5741The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5742write accesses to a memory region.
5743
5744While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5745memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5746etc. from accessing memory.
5747
5748@table @code
5749@item ro
5750Memory is read only.
5751@item wo
5752Memory is write only.
5753@item rw
6ca652b0 5754Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5755@end table
5756
5757@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5758The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5759accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5760require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5761specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5762
5763@table @code
5764@item 8
5765Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5766@item 16
5767Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5768@item 32
5769Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5770@item 64
5771Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5772@end table
5773
5774@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5775@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5776@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5777@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5778@c
5779@c @table @code
5780@c @item hwbreak
5781@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5782@c @item swbreak (default)
5783@c @end table
5784
5785@subsubsection Data Cache
5786The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5787memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5788protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5789does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5790registers.
5791
5792@table @code
5793@item cache
5794Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5795@item nocache
5796Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5797@end table
5798
5799@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5800@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5801@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5802@c
5803@c @table @code
5804@c @item verify
5805@c @item noverify (default)
5806@c @end table
5807
16d9dec6
MS
5808@node Dump/Restore Files
5809@section Copy between memory and a file
5810@cindex dump/restore files
5811@cindex append data to a file
5812@cindex dump data to a file
5813@cindex restore data from a file
5814@kindex dump
5815@kindex append
5816@kindex restore
5817
5818The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5819for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5820into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5821file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5822intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5823
5824@table @code
5825@kindex dump binary
5826@kindex append binary
5827@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5828Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5829raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5830
5831@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5832Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5833raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5834
5835@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5836Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5837
5838@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5839Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5840
5841@kindex dump ihex
5842@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5843Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5844intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5845
5846@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5847Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5848
5849@kindex dump srec
5850@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5851Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5852srec format file @var{filename}.
5853
5854@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5855Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5856
5857@kindex dump tekhex
5858@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5859Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5860tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5861
5862@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5863Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5864
42f9b0a5 5865@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5866Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5867command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5868raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5869@var{binary} after the filename.
5870
5871If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5872contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5873they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5874a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5875from that location.
5876
5877If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5878file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5879These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5880the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5881
5882@end table
5883
a0eb71c5
KB
5884@node Character Sets
5885@section Character Sets
5886@cindex character sets
5887@cindex charset
5888@cindex translating between character sets
5889@cindex host character set
5890@cindex target character set
5891
5892If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5893represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5894@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5895you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5896character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5897@dfn{target character set}.
5898
5899For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5900uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5901remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5902running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5903then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5904@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5905target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5906@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5907character and string literals in expressions.
5908
5909@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5910the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5911target-charset} command, described below.
5912
5913Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5914support:
5915
5916@table @code
5917@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5918@kindex set target-charset
5919Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5920character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5921@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5922the character sets it supports.
5923@end table
5924
5925@table @code
5926@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5927@kindex set host-charset
5928Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5929
5930By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5931system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5932@code{set host-charset} command.
5933
5934@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5935set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5936indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5937@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5938character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5939it can use as a host character set.
5940
5941@item set charset @var{charset}
5942@kindex set charset
5943Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5944invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5945character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5946sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5947asterisk (@samp{*}).
5948
5949@item show charset
5950@itemx show host-charset
5951@itemx show target-charset
5952@kindex show charset
5953@kindex show host-charset
5954@kindex show target-charset
5955Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
5956and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
5957charset}.
5958
5959@end table
5960
5961@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
5962sets:
5963
5964@table @code
5965
5966@item ASCII
5967@cindex ASCII character set
5968Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
5969character set.
5970
5971@item ISO-8859-1
5972@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
5973@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
5974The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
5975characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
5976this as its host character set.
5977
5978@item EBCDIC-US
5979@itemx IBM1047
5980@cindex EBCDIC character set
5981@cindex IBM1047 character set
5982Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
5983mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
5984@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
5985
5986@end table
5987
5988Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
5989GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
5990encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
5991
5992Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
5993Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
5994@file{charset-test.c}:
5995
5996@smallexample
5997#include <stdio.h>
5998
5999char ascii_hello[]
6000 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6001 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6002char ibm1047_hello[]
6003 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6004 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6005
6006main ()
6007@{
6008 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6009@}
6010@end example
6011
6012In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6013containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6014encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6015
6016We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6017
6018@smallexample
6019$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6020$ gdb -nw charset-test
6021GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6022Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6023@dots{}
6024(gdb)
6025@end example
6026
6027We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6028@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6029strings:
6030
6031@smallexample
6032(gdb) show charset
6033The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6034(gdb)
6035@end example
6036
6037For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6038initial character set:
6039@smallexample
6040(gdb) set charset ascii
6041(gdb) show charset
6042The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6043(gdb)
6044@end example
6045
6046Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6047host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6048characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6049them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6050@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6051
6052@smallexample
6053(gdb) print ascii_hello
6054$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6055(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6056$2 = 72 'H'
6057(gdb)
6058@end example
6059
6060@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6061literals you use in expressions:
6062
6063@smallexample
6064(gdb) print '+'
6065$3 = 43 '+'
6066(gdb)
6067@end example
6068
6069The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6070character.
6071
6072@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6073target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6074character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6075
6076@smallexample
6077(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6078$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6079(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6080$5 = 200 '\310'
6081(gdb)
6082@end example
6083
6084If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6085@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6086
6087@smallexample
6088(gdb) set target-charset
6089Valid character sets are:
6090 ascii *
6091 iso-8859-1 *
6092 ebcdic-us
6093 ibm1047
6094* - can be used as a host character set
6095@end example
6096
6097We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6098program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6099@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6100target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6101@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6102
6103@smallexample
6104(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6105(gdb) show charset
6106The current host character set is `ascii'.
6107The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6108(gdb) print ascii_hello
6109$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6110(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6111$7 = 72 '\110'
6112(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6113$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6114(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6115$9 = 200 'H'
6116(gdb)
6117@end example
6118
6119As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6120string literals you use in expressions:
6121
6122@smallexample
6123(gdb) print '+'
6124$10 = 78 '+'
6125(gdb)
6126@end example
6127
6128The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6129character.
6130
6131
e2e0bcd1
JB
6132@node Macros
6133@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6134
6135Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6136``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6137@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6138the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6139where it was defined.
6140
6141You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6142with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6143include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6144with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6145
6146A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6147and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6148points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6149no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6150uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6151@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6152see @ref{List}.
6153
6154At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6155token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6156variable-arity macros.
6157
6158Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6159macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6160the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6161
6162@table @code
6163
6164@kindex macro expand
6165@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6166@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6167@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6168@item macro expand @var{expression}
6169@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6170Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6171@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6172not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6173it can be any string of tokens.
6174
6175@kindex macro expand-once
6176@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6177@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6178@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6179expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6180@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6181left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6182particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6183expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6184parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6185can be any string of tokens.
6186
475b0867 6187@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6188@cindex macro definition, showing
6189@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6190@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6191Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6192source location where that definition was established.
6193
6194@kindex macro define
6195@cindex user-defined macros
6196@cindex defining macros interactively
6197@cindex macros, user-defined
6198@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6199@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6200@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6201preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6202by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6203command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6204second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6205given in @var{arglist}.
6206
6207A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6208evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6209undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6210definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6211well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6212
6213@kindex macro undef
6214@item macro undef @var{macro}
6215@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6216definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6217definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6218above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6219debugged.
6220
6221@end table
6222
6223@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6224Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6225show our source files:
6226
6227@smallexample
6228$ cat sample.c
6229#include <stdio.h>
6230#include "sample.h"
6231
6232#define M 42
6233#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6234
6235main ()
6236@{
6237#define N 28
6238 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6239#undef N
6240 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6241#define N 1729
6242 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6243@}
6244$ cat sample.h
6245#define Q <
6246$
6247@end smallexample
6248
6249Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6250We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6251compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6252information.
6253
6254@smallexample
6255$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6256$
6257@end smallexample
6258
6259Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6260
6261@smallexample
6262$ gdb -nw sample
6263GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6264Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6265GDB is free software, @dots{}
6266(gdb)
6267@end smallexample
6268
6269We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6270program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6271to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6272
6273@smallexample
6274(gdb) list main
62753
62764 #define M 42
62775 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
62786
62797 main ()
62808 @{
62819 #define N 28
628210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
628311 #undef N
628412 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6285(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6286Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6287#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6288(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6289Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6290 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6291#define Q <
6292(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6293expands to: (42 + 1)
6294(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6295expands to: once (M + 1)
6296(gdb)
6297@end smallexample
6298
6299In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6300the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6301@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6302which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6303
6304Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6305the source line of the current stack frame:
6306
6307@smallexample
6308(gdb) break main
6309Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6310(gdb) run
6311Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6312
6313Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
631410 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6315(gdb)
6316@end smallexample
6317
6318At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6319
6320@smallexample
475b0867 6321(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6322Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6323#define N 28
6324(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6325expands to: 28 < 42
6326(gdb) print N Q M
6327$1 = 1
6328(gdb)
6329@end smallexample
6330
6331As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6332give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6333thereof) in force at each point:
6334
6335@smallexample
6336(gdb) next
6337Hello, world!
633812 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6339(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6340The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6341at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6342(gdb) next
6343We're so creative.
634414 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6345(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6346Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6347#define N 1729
6348(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6349expands to: 1729 < 42
6350(gdb) print N Q M
6351$2 = 0
6352(gdb)
6353@end smallexample
6354
6355
b37052ae
EZ
6356@node Tracepoints
6357@chapter Tracepoints
6358@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6359@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6360
6361@cindex tracepoints
6362In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6363the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6364anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6365depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6366might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6367fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6368to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6369
6370Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6371specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6372arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6373Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6374those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6375expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6376for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6377a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6378in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6379values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6380unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6381
6382The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6383targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6384to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6385stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6386tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6387
6388This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6389
6390@menu
6391* Set Tracepoints::
6392* Analyze Collected Data::
6393* Tracepoint Variables::
6394@end menu
6395
6396@node Set Tracepoints
6397@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6398
6399Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6400tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6401tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6402breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6403one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6404tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6405work on.
6406
6407For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6408of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6409it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6410local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6411commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6412tracepoint was hit.
6413
6414This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6415conditions and actions.
6416
6417@menu
6418* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6419* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6420* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6421* Tracepoint Actions::
6422* Listing Tracepoints::
6423* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6424@end menu
6425
6426@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6427@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6428
6429@table @code
6430@cindex set tracepoint
6431@kindex trace
6432@item trace
6433The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6434Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6435the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6436defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6437debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6438program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6439doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6440cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6441running.
6442
6443Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6444
6445@smallexample
6446(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6447
6448(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6449
6450(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6451
6452(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6453
6454(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6455@end smallexample
6456
6457@noindent
6458You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6459
6460@vindex $tpnum
6461@cindex last tracepoint number
6462@cindex recent tracepoint number
6463@cindex tracepoint number
6464The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6465of the most recently set tracepoint.
6466
6467@kindex delete tracepoint
6468@cindex tracepoint deletion
6469@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6470Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6471default is to delete all tracepoints.
6472
6473Examples:
6474
6475@smallexample
6476(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6477
6478(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6479@end smallexample
6480
6481@noindent
6482You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6483@end table
6484
6485@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6486@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6487
6488@table @code
6489@kindex disable tracepoint
6490@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6491Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6492@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6493the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6494a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6495
6496@kindex enable tracepoint
6497@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6498Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6499tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6500run.
6501@end table
6502
6503@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6504@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6505
6506@table @code
6507@kindex passcount
6508@cindex tracepoint pass count
6509@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6510Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6511automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6512@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6513the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6514@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6515passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6516given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6517user.
6518
6519Examples:
6520
6521@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6522(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6523@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6524
6525(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6526@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6527(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6528(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6529(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6530(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6531(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6532(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6533@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6534@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6535@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6536@end smallexample
6537@end table
6538
6539@node Tracepoint Actions
6540@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6541
6542@table @code
6543@kindex actions
6544@cindex tracepoint actions
6545@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6546This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6547tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6548specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6549recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6550@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6551actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6552terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6553far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6554@code{while-stepping}.
6555
6556@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6557To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6558and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6559
6560@smallexample
6561(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6562
6826cf00 6563(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6564
6826cf00 6565(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6566@end smallexample
6567
6568In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6569commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6570hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6571following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6572followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6573@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6574@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6575@code{end} command.
6576
6577@smallexample
6578(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6580Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6581> collect bar,baz
6582> collect $regs
6583> while-stepping 12
6584 > collect $fp, $sp
6585 > end
6586end
6587@end smallexample
6588
6589@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6590@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6591Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6592This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6593In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6594special arguments are supported:
6595
6596@table @code
6597@item $regs
6598collect all registers
6599
6600@item $args
6601collect all function arguments
6602
6603@item $locals
6604collect all local variables.
6605@end table
6606
6607You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6608with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6609arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6610
f5c37c66
EZ
6611The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6612particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6613
b37052ae
EZ
6614@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6615@item while-stepping @var{n}
6616Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6617new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6618followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6619its own @code{end} command):
6620
6621@smallexample
6622> while-stepping 12
6623 > collect $regs, myglobal
6624 > end
6625>
6626@end smallexample
6627
6628@noindent
6629You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6630@code{stepping}.
6631@end table
6632
6633@node Listing Tracepoints
6634@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6635
6636@table @code
6637@kindex info tracepoints
6638@cindex information about tracepoints
6639@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6640Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6641a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6642defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6643shown:
6644
6645@itemize @bullet
6646@item
6647its number
6648@item
6649whether it is enabled or disabled
6650@item
6651its address
6652@item
6653its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6654@item
6655its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6656@item
6657where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6658@item
6659its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6660@end itemize
6661
6662@smallexample
6663(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6664Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
66651 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
66662 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
66673 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6668(@value{GDBP})
6669@end smallexample
6670
6671@noindent
6672This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6673@end table
6674
6675@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6676@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6677
6678@table @code
6679@kindex tstart
6680@cindex start a new trace experiment
6681@cindex collected data discarded
6682@item tstart
6683This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6684begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6685the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6686experiment.
6687
6688@kindex tstop
6689@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6690@item tstop
6691This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6692stops collecting data.
6693
6694@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6695automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6696(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6697
6698@kindex tstatus
6699@cindex status of trace data collection
6700@cindex trace experiment, status of
6701@item tstatus
6702This command displays the status of the current trace data
6703collection.
6704@end table
6705
6706Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6707
6708@smallexample
6709(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6710(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6711Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6712> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6713> while-stepping 11
6714 > collect $regs
6715 > end
6716> end
6717(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6718 [time passes @dots{}]
6719(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6720@end smallexample
6721
6722
6723@node Analyze Collected Data
6724@section Using the collected data
6725
6726After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6727for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6728collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6729snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6730consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6731examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6732specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6733snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6734registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6735rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6736debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6737(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6738behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6739when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6740the buffer will fail.
6741
6742@menu
6743* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6744* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6745* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6746@end menu
6747
6748@node tfind
6749@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6750
6751@kindex tfind
6752@cindex select trace snapshot
6753@cindex find trace snapshot
6754The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6755@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6756counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6757snapshot is selected.
6758
6759Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6760
6761@table @code
6762@item tfind start
6763Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6764@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6765
6766@item tfind none
6767Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6768
6769@item tfind end
6770Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6771
6772@item tfind
6773No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6774
6775@item tfind -
6776Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6777retracing earlier steps.
6778
6779@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6780Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6781proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6782argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6783for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6784
6785@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6786Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6787program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6788snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6789snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6790
6791@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6792Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6793addresses.
6794
6795@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6796Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6797@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6798
6799@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6800Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6801the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6802that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6803trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6804next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6805@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6806stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6807@end table
6808
6809The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6810designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6811instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6812snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6813trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6814simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6815snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6816@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6817The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6818for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6819no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6820(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6821no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6822tracepoint as the current one.
6823
6824In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6825these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6826scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6827you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6828registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6829
6830@smallexample
6831(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6832(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6833> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6834 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6835> tfind
6836> end
6837
6838Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6839Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6840Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6841Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6842Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6843Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6844Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6845Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6846Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6847Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6848Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6849@end smallexample
6850
6851Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6852the buffer:
6853
6854@smallexample
6855(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6856(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6857> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6858> tfind line
6859> end
6860
6861Frame 0, X = 1
6862Frame 7, X = 2
6863Frame 13, X = 255
6864@end smallexample
6865
6866@node tdump
6867@subsection @code{tdump}
6868@kindex tdump
6869@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6870@cindex tracepoint data, display
6871
6872This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6873the current trace snapshot.
6874
6875@smallexample
6876(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6877(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6878Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6879> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6880> end
6881
6882(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6883
6884(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6885#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6886at gdb_test.c:444
6887444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6888
6889(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6890Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6891d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6892d1 0x18 24
6893d2 0x80 128
6894d3 0x33 51
6895d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6896d5 0x22 34
6897d6 0xe0 224
6898d7 0x380035 3670069
6899a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6900a1 0x3000668 50333288
6901a2 0x100 256
6902a3 0x322000 3284992
6903a4 0x3000698 50333336
6904a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6905fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6906sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6907ps 0x0 0
6908pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6909fpcontrol 0x0 0
6910fpstatus 0x0 0
6911fpiaddr 0x0 0
6912p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6913p1 = (void *) 0x11
6914p2 = (void *) 0x22
6915p3 = (void *) 0x33
6916p4 = (void *) 0x44
6917p5 = (void *) 0x55
6918p6 = (void *) 0x66
6919gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6920
6921(@value{GDBP})
6922@end smallexample
6923
6924@node save-tracepoints
6925@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6926@kindex save-tracepoints
6927@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6928
6929This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6930their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6931suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6932tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6933Files}).
6934
6935@node Tracepoint Variables
6936@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6937@cindex tracepoint variables
6938@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6939
6940@table @code
6941@vindex $trace_frame
6942@item (int) $trace_frame
6943The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6944snapshot is selected.
6945
6946@vindex $tracepoint
6947@item (int) $tracepoint
6948The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6949
6950@vindex $trace_line
6951@item (int) $trace_line
6952The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6953
6954@vindex $trace_file
6955@item (char []) $trace_file
6956The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6957
6958@vindex $trace_func
6959@item (char []) $trace_func
6960The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6961@end table
6962
6963Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6964use @code{output} instead.
6965
6966Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6967stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6968data.
6969
6970@smallexample
6971(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6972
6973(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6974> output $trace_file
6975> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6976> tfind
6977> end
6978@end smallexample
6979
df0cd8c5
JB
6980@node Overlays
6981@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6982@cindex overlays
6983
6984If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6985memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6986problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6987use overlays.
6988
6989@menu
6990* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6991* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6992* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6993 mapped by asking the inferior.
6994* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6995@end menu
6996
6997@node How Overlays Work
6998@section How Overlays Work
6999@cindex mapped overlays
7000@cindex unmapped overlays
7001@cindex load address, overlay's
7002@cindex mapped address
7003@cindex overlay area
7004
7005Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7006kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7007other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7008management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7009adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7010
7011One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7012independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7013@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7014their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7015instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7016largest overlay as well.
7017
7018Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7019overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7020for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7021there.
7022
c928edc0
AC
7023@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7024@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7025@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7026
474c8240 7027@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7028@group
c928edc0
AC
7029 Data Instruction Larger
7030Address Space Address Space Address Space
7031+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7032| | | | | |
7033+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7034| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7035| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7036| and heap | | | | | |
7037+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7038| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7039+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7040 | | | | | |
7041 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7042 address | | | | | |
7043 | overlay | <-' | | |
7044 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7045 | | <---. | | load address
7046 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7047 | | | |
7048 +-----------+ | |
7049 +-----------+
7050 | |
7051 +-----------+
7052
7053 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7054@end group
474c8240 7055@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7056
c928edc0
AC
7057The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7058and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7059its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7060Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7061may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7062data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7063program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7064program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7065
7066An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7067@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7068instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7069in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7070is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7071the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7072called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7073
7074Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7075program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7076global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7077
7078@itemize @bullet
7079
7080@item
7081Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7082must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7083return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7084overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7085
7086@item
7087If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7088will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7089your program's performance.
7090
7091@item
7092The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7093overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7094mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7095and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7096You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7097addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7098ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7099
7100@item
7101The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7102to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7103instruction and data spaces.
7104
7105@end itemize
7106
7107The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7108improved in many ways:
7109
7110@itemize @bullet
7111
7112@item
7113If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7114hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7115contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7116This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7117area in the usual way.
7118
7119@item
7120If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7121overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7122
7123@item
7124You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7125general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7126code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7127return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7128the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7129must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7130different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7131
7132@end itemize
7133
7134
7135@node Overlay Commands
7136@section Overlay Commands
7137
7138To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7139correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7140virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7141mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7142@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7143variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7144
7145@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7146you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7147
7148@table @code
7149@item overlay off
7150@kindex overlay off
7151Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7152disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7153always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7154overlay support is disabled.
7155
7156@item overlay manual
7157@kindex overlay manual
7158@cindex manual overlay debugging
7159Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7160relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7161using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7162commands described below.
7163
7164@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7165@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7166@kindex overlay map-overlay
7167@cindex map an overlay
7168Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7169be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7170overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7171functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7172that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7173@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7174
7175@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7176@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7177@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7178@cindex unmap an overlay
7179Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7180must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7181When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7182overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7183
7184@item overlay auto
7185@kindex overlay auto
7186Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7187consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7188to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7189Overlay Debugging}.
7190
7191@item overlay load-target
7192@itemx overlay load
7193@kindex overlay load-target
7194@cindex reloading the overlay table
7195Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7196re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7197stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7198overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7199useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7200
7201@item overlay list-overlays
7202@itemx overlay list
7203@cindex listing mapped overlays
7204Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7205addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7206
7207@end table
7208
7209Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7210of the function the address falls in:
7211
474c8240 7212@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7213(gdb) print main
7214$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7215@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7216@noindent
7217When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7218unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7219asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7220unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7221
474c8240 7222@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7223(gdb) overlay list
7224No sections are mapped.
7225(gdb) print foo
7226$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7227@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7228@noindent
7229When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7230name normally:
7231
474c8240 7232@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7233(gdb) overlay list
7234Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7235 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7236(gdb) print foo
7237$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7238@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7239
7240When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7241address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7242overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7243@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7244code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7245
7246@itemize @bullet
7247@item
7248@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7249@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7250You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7251@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7252@item
7253@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7254unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7255overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7256you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7257breakpoints properly.
7258@end itemize
7259
7260
7261@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7262@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7263@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7264
7265@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7266are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7267inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7268@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7269looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7270current state of the overlays.
7271
7272Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7273@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7274
7275@table @asis
7276
7277@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7278This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7279
474c8240 7280@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7281struct
7282@{
7283 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7284 unsigned long vma;
7285
7286 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7287 unsigned long size;
7288
7289 /* The overlay's load address. */
7290 unsigned long lma;
7291
7292 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7293 zero otherwise. */
7294 unsigned long mapped;
7295@}
474c8240 7296@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7297
7298@item @code{_novlys}:
7299This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7300number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7301
7302@end table
7303
7304To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7305looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7306@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7307executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7308the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7309currently mapped.
7310
81d46470 7311In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7312@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7313will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7314calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7315will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7316are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7317in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7318overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7319are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7320
7321@node Overlay Sample Program
7322@section Overlay Sample Program
7323@cindex overlay example program
7324
7325When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7326at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7327addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7328Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7329since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7330architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7331portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7332
7333However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7334program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7335suite. The program consists of the following files from
7336@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7337
7338@table @file
7339@item overlays.c
7340The main program file.
7341@item ovlymgr.c
7342A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7343@item foo.c
7344@itemx bar.c
7345@itemx baz.c
7346@itemx grbx.c
7347Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7348@item d10v.ld
7349@itemx m32r.ld
7350Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7351and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7352@end table
7353
7354You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7355cross-compiler like this:
7356
474c8240 7357@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7358$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7359$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7360$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7361$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7362$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7363$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7364$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7365 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7366@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7367
7368The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7369you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7370target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7371
7372
6d2ebf8b 7373@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7374@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7375@cindex languages
7376
c906108c
SS
7377Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7378rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7379dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7380Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7381represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7382@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7383
7384@cindex working language
7385Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7386allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7387native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7388consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7389language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7390language}.
7391
7392@menu
7393* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7394* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7395* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7396* Support:: Supported languages
7397@end menu
7398
6d2ebf8b 7399@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7400@section Switching between source languages
7401
7402There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7403set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7404@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7405defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7406used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7407are printed, etc.
7408
7409In addition to the working language, every source file that
7410@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7411file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7412source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7413language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7414controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7415show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7416set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7417set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7418Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7419
7420This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7421as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7422another language. In that case, make the
7423program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7424@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7425program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7426
7427@menu
7428* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7429* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7430* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7431@end menu
7432
6d2ebf8b 7433@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7434@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7435
7436If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7437@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7438
7439@table @file
7440
7441@item .c
7442C source file
7443
7444@item .C
7445@itemx .cc
7446@itemx .cp
7447@itemx .cpp
7448@itemx .cxx
7449@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7450C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7451
7452@item .f
7453@itemx .F
7454Fortran source file
7455
db034ac5
AC
7456@c OBSOLETE @item .ch
7457@c OBSOLETE @itemx .c186
7458@c OBSOLETE @itemx .c286
7459@c OBSOLETE CHILL source file
c906108c 7460
c906108c
SS
7461@item .mod
7462Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7463
7464@item .s
7465@itemx .S
7466Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7467@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7468@end table
7469
7470In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7471extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7472
6d2ebf8b 7473@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7474@subsection Setting the working language
7475
7476If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7477expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7478your program.
7479
7480@kindex set language
7481If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7482command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7483a language, such as
c906108c 7484@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7485For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7486
c906108c
SS
7487Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7488language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7489to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7490source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7491languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7492source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7493command such as:
7494
474c8240 7495@smallexample
c906108c 7496print a = b + c
474c8240 7497@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7498
7499@noindent
7500might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7501@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7502printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7503@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7504
6d2ebf8b 7505@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7506@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7507
7508To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7509@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7510then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7511frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7512working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7513frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7514or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7515does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7516not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7517
7518This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7519entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7520written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7521a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7522case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7523
6d2ebf8b 7524@node Show
c906108c 7525@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7526
7527The following commands help you find out which language is the
7528working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7529
7530@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7531@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7532@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7533@table @code
7534@item show language
7535Display the current working language. This is the
7536language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7537build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7538
7539@item info frame
5d161b24 7540Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7541working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7542@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7543information listed here.
7544
7545@item info source
7546Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7547@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7548information listed here.
7549@end table
7550
7551In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7552not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7553with a language explicitly:
7554
7555@kindex set extension-language
7556@kindex info extensions
7557@table @code
7558@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7559Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7560the source language @var{language}.
7561
7562@item info extensions
7563List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7564@end table
7565
6d2ebf8b 7566@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7567@section Type and range checking
7568
7569@quotation
7570@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7571checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7572section documents the intended facilities.
7573@end quotation
7574@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7575
7576Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7577errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7578checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7579sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7580these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7581by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7582errors when your program is running.
7583
7584@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7585Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7586can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7587the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7588@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7589your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7590for the default settings of supported languages.
7591
7592@menu
7593* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7594* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7595@end menu
7596
7597@cindex type checking
7598@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7599@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7600@subsection An overview of type checking
7601
7602Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7603arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7604otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7605errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7606
7607@smallexample
76081 + 2 @result{} 3
7609@exdent but
7610@error{} 1 + 2.3
7611@end smallexample
7612
7613The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7614type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7615
5d161b24
DB
7616For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7617@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7618to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7619or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7620but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7621these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7622also issues a warning.
7623
5d161b24
DB
7624Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7625related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7626For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7627a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7628with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7629the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7630
7631Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7632instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7633operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7634represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7635operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7636details on specific languages.
7637
7638@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7639
d4f3574e 7640@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7641@kindex set check type
7642@kindex show check type
7643@table @code
7644@item set check type auto
7645Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7646@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7647each language.
7648
7649@item set check type on
7650@itemx set check type off
7651Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7652current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7653match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7654evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7655message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7656
7657@item set check type warn
7658Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7659evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7660be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7661numbers and structures.
7662
7663@item show type
5d161b24 7664Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7665is setting it automatically.
7666@end table
7667
7668@cindex range checking
7669@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7670@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7671@subsection An overview of range checking
7672
7673In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7674bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7675checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7676computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7677not exceed the bounds of the array.
7678
7679For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7680@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7681always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7682warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7683
7684A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7685array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7686of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7687error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7688result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7689the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7690
474c8240 7691@smallexample
c906108c 7692@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7693@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7694
7695This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7696specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7697Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7698
7699@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7700
d4f3574e 7701@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7702@kindex set check range
7703@kindex show check range
7704@table @code
7705@item set check range auto
7706Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7707@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7708each language.
7709
7710@item set check range on
7711@itemx set check range off
7712Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7713current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7714match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7715then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7716
7717@item set check range warn
7718Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7719but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7720expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7721memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7722systems).
7723
7724@item show range
7725Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7726being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7727@end table
c906108c 7728
6d2ebf8b 7729@node Support
c906108c 7730@section Supported languages
c906108c 7731
db034ac5
AC
7732@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java,
7733@c OBSOLETE Chill,
7734assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7735@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7736Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7737language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7738and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7739,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7740language.
7741
7742The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7743supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7744tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7745@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7746formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7747books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7748language reference or tutorial.
7749
c906108c 7750@menu
b37052ae 7751* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7752* Modula-2:: Modula-2
db034ac5 7753@c OBSOLETE * Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
7754@end menu
7755
6d2ebf8b 7756@node C
b37052ae 7757@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7758
b37052ae
EZ
7759@cindex C and C@t{++}
7760@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7761
b37052ae 7762Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7763to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7764together.
7765
41afff9a
EZ
7766@cindex C@t{++}
7767@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7768@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7769The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7770compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7771effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7772C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7773compiler (@code{aCC}).
7774
b37052ae 7775For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7776format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7777command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7778@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7779CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7780
c906108c 7781@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7782* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7783* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7784* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7785* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7786* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7787* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7788* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7789@end menu
c906108c 7790
6d2ebf8b 7791@node C Operators
b37052ae 7792@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7793
b37052ae 7794@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7795
7796Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7797@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7798often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7799
b37052ae 7800For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7801
7802@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7803
c906108c 7804@item
c906108c 7805@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7806specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7807
7808@item
d4f3574e
SS
7809@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7810@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7811
7812@item
53a5351d 7813@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7814
7815@item
7816@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7817
c906108c
SS
7818@end itemize
7819
7820@noindent
7821The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7822in order of increasing precedence:
7823
7824@table @code
7825@item ,
7826The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7827are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7828expression being the last expression evaluated.
7829
7830@item =
7831Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7832assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7833
7834@item @var{op}=
7835Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7836and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7837@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7838@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7839@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7840
7841@item ?:
7842The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7843of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7844integral type.
7845
7846@item ||
7847Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7848
7849@item &&
7850Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7851
7852@item |
7853Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7854
7855@item ^
7856Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7857
7858@item &
7859Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7860
7861@item ==@r{, }!=
7862Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7863expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7864
7865@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7866Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7867Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7868and non-zero for true.
7869
7870@item <<@r{, }>>
7871left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7872
7873@item @@
7874The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7875
7876@item +@r{, }-
7877Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7878pointer types.
7879
7880@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7881Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7882defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7883integral types.
7884
7885@item ++@r{, }--
7886Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7887operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7888when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7889operation takes place.
7890
7891@item *
7892Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7893@code{++}.
7894
7895@item &
7896Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7897
b37052ae
EZ
7898For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7899allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7900(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7901where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7902stored.
c906108c
SS
7903
7904@item -
7905Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7906precedence as @code{++}.
7907
7908@item !
7909Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7910@code{++}.
7911
7912@item ~
7913Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7914@code{++}.
7915
7916
7917@item .@r{, }->
7918Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7919@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7920pointer based on the stored type information.
7921Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7922
c906108c
SS
7923@item .*@r{, }->*
7924Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7925
7926@item []
7927Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7928@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7929
7930@item ()
7931Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7932
c906108c 7933@item ::
b37052ae 7934C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7935and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7936
7937@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7938Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7939(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7940above.
c906108c
SS
7941@end table
7942
c906108c
SS
7943If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7944attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7945predefined meaning.
c906108c 7946
c906108c 7947@menu
5d161b24 7948* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7949@end menu
7950
6d2ebf8b 7951@node C Constants
b37052ae 7952@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7953
b37052ae 7954@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7955
b37052ae 7956@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7957following ways:
c906108c
SS
7958
7959@itemize @bullet
7960@item
7961Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7962specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7963by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7964@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7965@code{long} value.
7966
7967@item
7968Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7969point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7970exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7971@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7972sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7973A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7974@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7975the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7976a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7977constant.
c906108c
SS
7978
7979@item
7980Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7981integral equivalents.
7982
7983@item
7984Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7985(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7986(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7987be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7988the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7989of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7990@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7991@samp{\n} for newline.
7992
7993@item
96a2c332
SS
7994String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7995double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7996above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7997a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7998characters.
c906108c
SS
7999
8000@item
8001Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8002to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8003
8004@item
8005Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8006and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8007integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8008and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8009@end itemize
8010
c906108c 8011@menu
5d161b24
DB
8012* C plus plus expressions::
8013* C Defaults::
8014* C Checks::
c906108c 8015
5d161b24 8016* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8017@end menu
8018
6d2ebf8b 8019@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8020@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8021
8022@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8023@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8024
8025@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8026@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8027@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8028@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8029@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8030@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8031@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8032@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8033@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8034@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8035@c periodically whether this has happened...
8036@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
8037@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8038proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
8039additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8040special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8041@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8042symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8043you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8044extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 8045@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8046support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8047@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8048
8049@enumerate
8050
8051@cindex member functions
8052@item
8053Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8054
474c8240 8055@smallexample
c906108c 8056count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8057@end smallexample
c906108c 8058
41afff9a 8059@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8060@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8061@item
8062While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8063expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8064that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8065pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8066
c906108c 8067@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8068@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8069@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8070@item
8071You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8072call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8073perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8074calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8075in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8076default arguments.
8077
8078It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8079promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8080class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8081functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8082number of function arguments.
8083
8084Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8085@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8086,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8087
d4f3574e 8088You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8089explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8090@smallexample
8091p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8092@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8093
c906108c 8094The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8095see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8096
c906108c
SS
8097@cindex reference declarations
8098@item
b37052ae
EZ
8099@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8100them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8101dereferenced.
8102
8103In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8104reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8105avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8106The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8107you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8108
8109@item
b37052ae 8110@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8111expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8112one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8113necessary, for example in an expression like
8114@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8115resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8116debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8117@end enumerate
8118
b37052ae 8119In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8120calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8121objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8122invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8123
6d2ebf8b 8124@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8125@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8126
b37052ae 8127@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8128
c906108c
SS
8129If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8130both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8131C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8132selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8133
8134If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8135recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8136@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8137these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8138@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8139for further details.
8140
c906108c
SS
8141@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8142@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8143@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8144
6d2ebf8b 8145@node C Checks
b37052ae 8146@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8147
b37052ae 8148@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8149
b37052ae 8150By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8151is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8152considers two variables type equivalent if:
8153
8154@itemize @bullet
8155@item
8156The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8157enumerated tag.
8158
8159@item
8160The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8161declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8162
8163@ignore
8164@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8165@c FIXME--beers?
8166@item
8167The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8168declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8169compilers.)
8170@end ignore
8171@end itemize
8172
8173Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8174indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8175that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8176
6d2ebf8b 8177@node Debugging C
c906108c 8178@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8179
8180The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8181the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8182inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8183appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8184
8185The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8186with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8187,Expressions}.
8188
c906108c 8189@menu
5d161b24 8190* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8191@end menu
8192
6d2ebf8b 8193@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8194@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8195
b37052ae 8196@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8197
b37052ae
EZ
8198Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8199designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8200
8201@table @code
8202@cindex break in overloaded functions
8203@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8204When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8205@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8206you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8207
b37052ae 8208@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8209@item rbreak @var{regex}
8210Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8211breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8212classes.
8213@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8214
b37052ae 8215@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8216@item catch throw
8217@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8218Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8219Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8220
8221@cindex inheritance
8222@item ptype @var{typename}
8223Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8224@var{typename}.
8225@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8226
b37052ae 8227@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8228@item set print demangle
8229@itemx show print demangle
8230@itemx set print asm-demangle
8231@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8232Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8233displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8234@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8235
8236@item set print object
8237@itemx show print object
8238Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8239@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8240
8241@item set print vtbl
8242@itemx show print vtbl
8243Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8244@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8245(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8246ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8247
8248@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8249@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8250@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8251Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8252is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8253and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8254using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8255expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8256message.
8257
8258@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8259Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8260overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8261chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8262symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8263overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8264searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8265argument types.
c906108c
SS
8266
8267@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8268You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8269the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8270@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8271also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8272available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8273@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8274@end table
c906108c 8275
6d2ebf8b 8276@node Modula-2
c906108c 8277@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8278
d4f3574e 8279@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8280
8281The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8282output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8283developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8284attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8285to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8286table.
8287
8288@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8289@menu
8290* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8291* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8292* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8293* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8294* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8295* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8296* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8297* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8298@end menu
8299
6d2ebf8b 8300@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8301@subsubsection Operators
8302@cindex Modula-2 operators
8303
8304Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8305@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8306often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8307following definitions hold:
8308
8309@itemize @bullet
8310
8311@item
8312@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8313their subranges.
8314
8315@item
8316@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8317
8318@item
8319@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8320
8321@item
8322@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8323@var{type}}.
8324
8325@item
8326@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8327
8328@item
8329@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8330
8331@item
8332@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8333@end itemize
8334
8335@noindent
8336The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8337increasing precedence:
8338
8339@table @code
8340@item ,
8341Function argument or array index separator.
8342
8343@item :=
8344Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8345@var{value}.
8346
8347@item <@r{, }>
8348Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8349types.
8350
8351@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8352Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8353on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8354set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8355
8356@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8357Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8358Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8359available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8360comment character.
8361
8362@item IN
8363Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8364Same precedence as @code{<}.
8365
8366@item OR
8367Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8368
8369@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8370Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8371
8372@item @@
8373The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8374
8375@item +@r{, }-
8376Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8377and difference on set types.
8378
8379@item *
8380Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8381on set types.
8382
8383@item /
8384Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8385types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8386
8387@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8388Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8389precedence as @code{*}.
8390
8391@item -
8392Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8393
8394@item ^
8395Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8396
8397@item NOT
8398Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8399@code{^}.
8400
8401@item .
8402@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8403precedence as @code{^}.
8404
8405@item []
8406Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8407
8408@item ()
8409Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8410as @code{^}.
8411
8412@item ::@r{, }.
8413@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8414@end table
8415
8416@quotation
8417@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8418treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8419@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8420@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8421@end quotation
8422
cb51c4e0 8423
6d2ebf8b 8424@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8425@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8426@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8427
8428Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8429In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8430
8431@table @var
8432
8433@item a
8434represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8435
8436@item c
8437represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8438
8439@item i
8440represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8441
8442@item m
8443represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8444same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8445be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8446
8447@item n
8448represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8449
8450@item r
8451represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8452
8453@item t
8454represents a type.
8455
8456@item v
8457represents a variable.
8458
8459@item x
8460represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8461explanation of the function for details.
8462@end table
8463
8464All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8465
8466@table @code
8467@item ABS(@var{n})
8468Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8469
8470@item CAP(@var{c})
8471If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8472equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8473
8474@item CHR(@var{i})
8475Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8476
8477@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8478Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8479
8480@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8481Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8482new value.
8483
8484@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8485Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8486set.
8487
8488@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8489Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8490
8491@item HIGH(@var{a})
8492Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8493
8494@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8495Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8496
8497@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8498Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8499new value.
8500
8501@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8502Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8503there. Returns the new set.
8504
8505@item MAX(@var{t})
8506Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8507
8508@item MIN(@var{t})
8509Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8510
8511@item ODD(@var{i})
8512Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8513
8514@item ORD(@var{x})
8515Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8516value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8517@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8518integral, character and enumerated types.
8519
8520@item SIZE(@var{x})
8521Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8522
8523@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8524Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8525
8526@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8527Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8528@end table
8529
8530@quotation
8531@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8532@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8533an error.
8534@end quotation
8535
8536@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8537@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8538@subsubsection Constants
8539
8540@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8541ways:
8542
8543@itemize @bullet
8544
8545@item
8546Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8547expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8548rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8549trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8550
8551@item
8552Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8553decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8554then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8555@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8556digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8557digits.
8558
8559@item
8560Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8561like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8562also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8563followed by a @samp{C}.
8564
8565@item
8566String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8567pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8568Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8569Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8570sequences.
8571
8572@item
8573Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8574
8575@item
8576Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8577@code{FALSE}.
8578
8579@item
8580Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8581
8582@item
8583Set constants are not yet supported.
8584@end itemize
8585
6d2ebf8b 8586@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8587@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8588@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8589
8590If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8591both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8592Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8593selected the working language.
8594
8595If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8596code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8597working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8598the language automatically}, for further details.
8599
6d2ebf8b 8600@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8601@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8602@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8603
8604A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8605This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8606
8607@itemize @bullet
8608@item
8609Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8610integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8611debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8612pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8613through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8614returned a pointer.)
8615
8616@item
8617C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8618non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8619escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8620printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8621
8622@item
8623The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8624argument.
8625
8626@item
8627All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8628@end itemize
8629
6d2ebf8b 8630@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8631@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8632@cindex Modula-2 checks
8633
8634@quotation
8635@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8636range checking.
8637@end quotation
8638@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8639
8640@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8641
8642@itemize @bullet
8643@item
8644They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8645@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8646
8647@item
8648They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8649@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8650@end itemize
8651
8652As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8653whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8654
8655Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8656index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8657
6d2ebf8b 8658@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8659@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8660@cindex scope
41afff9a 8661@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8662@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8663@ifinfo
41afff9a 8664@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8665@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8666@end ifinfo
8667@iftex
41afff9a 8668@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8669@end iftex
8670
8671There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8672(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8673similar syntax:
8674
474c8240 8675@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8676
8677@var{module} . @var{id}
8678@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8679@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8680
8681@noindent
8682where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8683@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8684identifier within your program, except another module.
8685
8686Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8687specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8688found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8689enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8690
8691Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8692the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8693definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8694an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8695module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8696@var{module}.
8697
6d2ebf8b 8698@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8699@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8700
8701Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8702Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8703specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8704@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8705apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8706analogue in Modula-2.
8707
8708The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8709with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8710intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8711created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8712address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8713@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8714
8715@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8716In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8717interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8718
db034ac5
AC
8719@c OBSOLETE @node Chill
8720@c OBSOLETE @subsection Chill
8721@c OBSOLETE
8722@c OBSOLETE The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
8723@c OBSOLETE from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
8724@c OBSOLETE supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8725@c OBSOLETE likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8726@c OBSOLETE table.
8727@c OBSOLETE
8728@c OBSOLETE @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8729@c OBSOLETE @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8730@c OBSOLETE This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
8731@c OBSOLETE of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8732@c OBSOLETE
8733@c OBSOLETE @menu
8734@c OBSOLETE * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8735@c OBSOLETE * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
8736@c OBSOLETE * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
8737@c OBSOLETE * Chill type and range checks::
8738@c OBSOLETE * Chill defaults::
8739@c OBSOLETE @end menu
8740@c OBSOLETE
8741@c OBSOLETE @node How modes are displayed
8742@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection How modes are displayed
8743@c OBSOLETE
8744@c OBSOLETE The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
8745@c OBSOLETE with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
8746@c OBSOLETE slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8747@c OBSOLETE provided modes are:
8748@c OBSOLETE
8749@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8750@c OBSOLETE @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
8751@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8752@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8753@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8754@c OBSOLETE @item
8755@c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8756@c OBSOLETE UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8757@c OBSOLETE @item
8758@c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
8759@c OBSOLETE @item
8760@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
8761@c OBSOLETE @item
8762@c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8763@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8764@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8765@c OBSOLETE type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8766@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8767@c OBSOLETE If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8768@c OBSOLETE @item
8769@c OBSOLETE @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8770@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8771@c OBSOLETE @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8772@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8773@c OBSOLETE where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8774@c OBSOLETE expression (e.g. set element names).
8775@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8776@c OBSOLETE
8777@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8778@c OBSOLETE A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
8779@c OBSOLETE the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
8780@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8781@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8782@c OBSOLETE type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8783@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8784@c OBSOLETE
8785@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8786@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8787@c OBSOLETE @item
8788@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
8789@c OBSOLETE followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8790@c OBSOLETE @item
8791@c OBSOLETE @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8792@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8793@c OBSOLETE
8794@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8795@c OBSOLETE The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8796@c OBSOLETE <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
8797@c OBSOLETE list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8798@c OBSOLETE the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
8799@c OBSOLETE all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8800@c OBSOLETE
8801@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8802@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8803@c OBSOLETE The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
8804@c OBSOLETE type, and is therefore not really of interest.
8805@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8806@c OBSOLETE
8807@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
8808@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8809@c OBSOLETE @item
8810@c OBSOLETE @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8811@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8812@c OBSOLETE @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8813@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8814@c OBSOLETE where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8815@c OBSOLETE @item
8816@c OBSOLETE @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8817@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8818@c OBSOLETE @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8819@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8820@c OBSOLETE where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
8821@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8822@c OBSOLETE
8823@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
8824@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8825@c OBSOLETE @item
8826@c OBSOLETE @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8827@c OBSOLETE @item
8828@c OBSOLETE @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8829@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8830@c OBSOLETE
8831@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8832@c OBSOLETE Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8833@c OBSOLETE
8834@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8835@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8836@c OBSOLETE @item
8837@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8838@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8839@c OBSOLETE @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8840@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8841@c OBSOLETE followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8842@c OBSOLETE mode
8843@c OBSOLETE @item
8844@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8845@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8846@c OBSOLETE @code{BOOLS(<string
8847@c OBSOLETE length>)}
8848@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8849@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8850@c OBSOLETE
8851@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8852@c OBSOLETE The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8853@c OBSOLETE followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8854@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8855@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8856@c OBSOLETE type = ARRAY (1:42)
8857@c OBSOLETE ARRAY (1:20)
8858@c OBSOLETE SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8859@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8860@c OBSOLETE
8861@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
8862@c OBSOLETE The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
8863@c OBSOLETE list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8864@c OBSOLETE of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8865@c OBSOLETE OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
8866@c OBSOLETE of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8867@c OBSOLETE checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8868@c OBSOLETE always displays all variant fields.
8869@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8870@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8871@c OBSOLETE type = STRUCT (
8872@c OBSOLETE as x,
8873@c OBSOLETE bs x,
8874@c OBSOLETE CASE bs OF
8875@c OBSOLETE (karli):
8876@c OBSOLETE cs a
8877@c OBSOLETE (ott):
8878@c OBSOLETE ds x
8879@c OBSOLETE ESAC
8880@c OBSOLETE )
8881@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8882@c OBSOLETE @end table
8883@c OBSOLETE
8884@c OBSOLETE @node Locations
8885@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8886@c OBSOLETE
8887@c OBSOLETE A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8888@c OBSOLETE
8889@c OBSOLETE A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
8890@c OBSOLETE the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8891@c OBSOLETE Chill programs. How values are specified
8892@c OBSOLETE is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
8893@c OBSOLETE
8894@c OBSOLETE The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8895@c OBSOLETE display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
8896@c OBSOLETE
8897@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8898@c OBSOLETE set result := EXPR
8899@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8900@c OBSOLETE
8901@c OBSOLETE @noindent
8902@c OBSOLETE This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
8903@c OBSOLETE is not available in @value{GDBN}).
8904@c OBSOLETE
8905@c OBSOLETE Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8906@c OBSOLETE value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
8907@c OBSOLETE mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
8908@c OBSOLETE represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8909@c OBSOLETE value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
8910@c OBSOLETE operator @samp{->}.
8911@c OBSOLETE
8912@c OBSOLETE Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8913@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8914@c OBSOLETE @code{@{ PROC
8915@c OBSOLETE (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
8916@c OBSOLETE location>}
8917@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8918@c OBSOLETE @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8919@c OBSOLETE specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8920@c OBSOLETE the entry point.
8921@c OBSOLETE
8922@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8923@c OBSOLETE Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8924@c OBSOLETE fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8925@c OBSOLETE the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
8926@c OBSOLETE implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8927@c OBSOLETE na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8928@c OBSOLETE <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
8929@c OBSOLETE @code{__proc_copy}.
8930@c OBSOLETE
8931@c OBSOLETE Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8932@c OBSOLETE the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8933@c OBSOLETE like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8934@c OBSOLETE mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8935@c OBSOLETE
8936@c OBSOLETE Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
8937@c OBSOLETE ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
8938@c OBSOLETE definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
8939@c OBSOLETE of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8940@c OBSOLETE structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8941@c OBSOLETE braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
8942@c OBSOLETE on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
8943@c OBSOLETE memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
8944@c OBSOLETE all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
8945@c OBSOLETE @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
8946@c OBSOLETE stuff ???)
8947@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8948@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8949@c OBSOLETE [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8950@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8951@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8952@c OBSOLETE
8953@c OBSOLETE Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8954@c OBSOLETE (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
8955@c OBSOLETE certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8956@c OBSOLETE and their Operations}.
8957@c OBSOLETE
8958@c OBSOLETE A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
8959@c OBSOLETE location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8960@c OBSOLETE name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8961@c OBSOLETE have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8962@c OBSOLETE checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
8963@c OBSOLETE therefore the result can be quite confusing.
8964@c OBSOLETE
8965@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8966@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8967@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8968@c OBSOLETE
8969@c OBSOLETE @node Values and their Operations
8970@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Values and their Operations
8971@c OBSOLETE
8972@c OBSOLETE Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8973@c OBSOLETE more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
8974@c OBSOLETE data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8975@c OBSOLETE such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
8976@c OBSOLETE constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
8977@c OBSOLETE when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
8978@c OBSOLETE (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8979@c OBSOLETE the values behind these locations.
8980@c OBSOLETE
8981@c OBSOLETE This section describes how values have to be specified and which
8982@c OBSOLETE operations are legal to be used with such values.
8983@c OBSOLETE
8984@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8985@c OBSOLETE @item Literal Values
8986@c OBSOLETE Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8987@c OBSOLETE For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
8988@c OBSOLETE chapter 1.5.
8989@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8990@c OBSOLETE @c be converted to a @ref.
8991@c OBSOLETE
8992@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8993@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8994@c OBSOLETE @item
8995@c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8996@c OBSOLETE programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
8997@c OBSOLETE @item
8998@c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8999@c OBSOLETE @item
9000@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
9001@c OBSOLETE @code{'M'})
9002@c OBSOLETE @item
9003@c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
9004@c OBSOLETE mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
9005@c OBSOLETE comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
9006@c OBSOLETE @item
9007@c OBSOLETE @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
9008@c OBSOLETE emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
9009@c OBSOLETE procedure value or the empty instance value.
9010@c OBSOLETE
9011@c OBSOLETE @item
9012@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
9013@c OBSOLETE enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
9014@c OBSOLETE to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
9015@c OBSOLETE @item
9016@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
9017@c OBSOLETE programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
9018@c OBSOLETE @item
9019@c OBSOLETE @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
9020@c OBSOLETE (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
9021@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
9022@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
9023@c OBSOLETE
9024@c OBSOLETE @item Tuple Values
9025@c OBSOLETE A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
9026@c OBSOLETE name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
9027@c OBSOLETE unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
9028@c OBSOLETE @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
9029@c OBSOLETE
9030@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
9031@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
9032@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Array Tuple}
9033@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
9034@c OBSOLETE Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
9035@c OBSOLETE same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
9036@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
9037@c OBSOLETE
9038@c OBSOLETE @item String Element Value
9039@c OBSOLETE A string element value is specified by
9040@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
9041@c OBSOLETE @code{<string value>(<index>)}
9042@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
9043@c OBSOLETE where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
9044@c OBSOLETE value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
9045@c OBSOLETE the string.
9046@c OBSOLETE
9047@c OBSOLETE @item String Slice Value
9048@c OBSOLETE A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
9049@c OBSOLETE spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
9050@c OBSOLETE expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
9051@c OBSOLETE @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
9052@c OBSOLETE The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
9053@c OBSOLETE string.
9054@c OBSOLETE
9055@c OBSOLETE @item Array Element Values
9056@c OBSOLETE An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
9057@c OBSOLETE delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
9058@c OBSOLETE
9059@c OBSOLETE @item Array Slice Values
9060@c OBSOLETE An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
9061@c OBSOLETE @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
9062@c OBSOLETE @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
9063@c OBSOLETE arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
9064@c OBSOLETE which is part of the specified array.
9065@c OBSOLETE
9066@c OBSOLETE @item Structure Field Values
9067@c OBSOLETE A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
9068@c OBSOLETE name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
9069@c OBSOLETE in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
9070@c OBSOLETE corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
9071@c OBSOLETE
9072@c OBSOLETE @item Procedure Call Value
9073@c OBSOLETE The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
9074@c OBSOLETE procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
9075@c OBSOLETE expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
9076@c OBSOLETE effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
9077@c OBSOLETE
9078@c OBSOLETE Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
9079@c OBSOLETE
9080@c OBSOLETE Values of time mode locations appear as
9081@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
9082@c OBSOLETE @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
9083@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
9084@c OBSOLETE
9085@c OBSOLETE
9086@c OBSOLETE @ignore
9087@c OBSOLETE This is not implemented yet:
9088@c OBSOLETE @item Built-in Value
9089@c OBSOLETE @noindent
9090@c OBSOLETE The following built in functions are provided:
9091@c OBSOLETE
9092@c OBSOLETE @table @code
9093@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ADDR()}
9094@c OBSOLETE @item @code{NUM()}
9095@c OBSOLETE @item @code{PRED()}
9096@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SUCC()}
9097@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ABS()}
9098@c OBSOLETE @item @code{CARD()}
9099@c OBSOLETE @item @code{MAX()}
9100@c OBSOLETE @item @code{MIN()}
9101@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIZE()}
9102@c OBSOLETE @item @code{UPPER()}
9103@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOWER()}
9104@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LENGTH()}
9105@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIN()}
9106@c OBSOLETE @item @code{COS()}
9107@c OBSOLETE @item @code{TAN()}
9108@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCSIN()}
9109@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCCOS()}
9110@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCTAN()}
9111@c OBSOLETE @item @code{EXP()}
9112@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LN()}
9113@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOG()}
9114@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SQRT()}
9115@c OBSOLETE @end table
9116@c OBSOLETE
9117@c OBSOLETE For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
9118@c OBSOLETE chapter 1.6.
9119@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
9120@c OBSOLETE
9121@c OBSOLETE @item Zero-adic Operator Value
9122@c OBSOLETE The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
9123@c OBSOLETE current active process.
9124@c OBSOLETE
9125@c OBSOLETE @item Expression Values
9126@c OBSOLETE The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
9127@c OBSOLETE the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
9128@c OBSOLETE incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
9129@c OBSOLETE corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
9130@c OBSOLETE causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
9131@c OBSOLETE which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
9132@c OBSOLETE operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
9133@c OBSOLETE
9134@c OBSOLETE @table @code
9135@c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
9136@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
9137@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
9138@c OBSOLETE Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
9139@c OBSOLETE
9140@c OBSOLETE @item @code{=, /=}
9141@c OBSOLETE Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
9142@c OBSOLETE
9143@c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
9144@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
9145@c OBSOLETE Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
9146@c OBSOLETE
9147@c OBSOLETE @item @code{+, -}
9148@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
9149@c OBSOLETE Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
9150@c OBSOLETE
9151@c OBSOLETE @item @code{-}
9152@c OBSOLETE Change sign operator.
9153@c OBSOLETE
9154@c OBSOLETE @item @code{//}
9155@c OBSOLETE String concatenation operator.
9156@c OBSOLETE
9157@c OBSOLETE @item @code{()}
9158@c OBSOLETE String repetition operator.
9159@c OBSOLETE
9160@c OBSOLETE @item @code{->}
9161@c OBSOLETE Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
9162@c OBSOLETE address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
9163@c OBSOLETE location (@code{loc->}).
9164@c OBSOLETE
9165@c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, XOR}
9166@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND}
9167@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
9168@c OBSOLETE Powerset and bitstring operators.
9169@c OBSOLETE
9170@c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
9171@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
9172@c OBSOLETE Powerset inclusion operators.
9173@c OBSOLETE
9174@c OBSOLETE @item @code{IN}
9175@c OBSOLETE Membership operator.
9176@c OBSOLETE @end table
9177@c OBSOLETE @end table
9178@c OBSOLETE
9179@c OBSOLETE @node Chill type and range checks
9180@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
9181@c OBSOLETE
9182@c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
9183@c OBSOLETE of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
9184@c OBSOLETE complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
9185@c OBSOLETE equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
9186@c OBSOLETE structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
9187@c OBSOLETE
9188@c OBSOLETE Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
9189@c OBSOLETE index bounds and all built in procedures.
9190@c OBSOLETE
9191@c OBSOLETE Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
9192@c OBSOLETE check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
9193@c OBSOLETE operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
9194@c OBSOLETE functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
9195@c OBSOLETE language specification.
9196@c OBSOLETE
9197@c OBSOLETE All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
9198@c OBSOLETE off}.
9199@c OBSOLETE
9200@c OBSOLETE @ignore
9201@c OBSOLETE @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
9202@c OBSOLETE see last paragraph ?
9203@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
9204@c OBSOLETE
9205@c OBSOLETE @node Chill defaults
9206@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill defaults
9207@c OBSOLETE
9208@c OBSOLETE If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
9209@c OBSOLETE both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
9210@c OBSOLETE Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9211@c OBSOLETE selected the working language.
9212@c OBSOLETE
9213@c OBSOLETE If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
9214@c OBSOLETE code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
9215@c OBSOLETE working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
9216@c OBSOLETE the language automatically}, for further details.
cce74817 9217
6d2ebf8b 9218@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
9219@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
9220
d4f3574e 9221The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
9222symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
9223program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
9224does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
9225program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
9226(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
9227file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9228
9229@cindex symbol names
9230@cindex names of symbols
9231@cindex quoting names
9232Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
9233characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
9234most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
9235source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
9236are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
9237ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
9238@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
9239@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
9240
474c8240 9241@smallexample
c906108c 9242p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 9243@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9244
9245@noindent
9246looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
9247
9248@table @code
9249@kindex info address
b37052ae 9250@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
9251@item info address @var{symbol}
9252Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
9253variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
9254local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
9255is always stored.
9256
9257Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
9258at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
9259the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
9260
3d67e040 9261@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 9262@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
9263@item info symbol @var{addr}
9264Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
9265If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
9266nearest symbol and an offset from it:
9267
474c8240 9268@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
9269(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
9270_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 9271@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
9272
9273@noindent
9274This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
9275it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
9276
c906108c 9277@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
9278@item whatis @var{expr}
9279Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
9280actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
9281assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
9282@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9283
9284@item whatis
9285Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9286
9287@kindex ptype
9288@item ptype @var{typename}
9289Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
9290the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
9291@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
9292@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 9293
d4f3574e 9294@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 9295@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 9296Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
9297differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
9298of just the name of the type.
9299
9300For example, for this variable declaration:
9301
474c8240 9302@smallexample
c906108c 9303struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 9304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9305
9306@noindent
9307the two commands give this output:
9308
474c8240 9309@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9310@group
9311(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
9312type = struct complex
9313(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
9314type = struct complex @{
9315 double real;
9316 double imag;
9317@}
9318@end group
474c8240 9319@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9320
9321@noindent
9322As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
9323the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9324
9325@kindex info types
9326@item info types @var{regexp}
9327@itemx info types
d4f3574e 9328Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
9329(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9330complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9331@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 9332names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
9333information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9334
9335This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9336@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9337lists all source files where a type is defined.
9338
b37052ae
EZ
9339@kindex info scope
9340@cindex local variables
9341@item info scope @var{addr}
9342List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9343accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9344preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9345scope defined by that location. For example:
9346
9347@smallexample
9348(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9349Scope for command_line_handler:
9350Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9351Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9352Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9353Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9354Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9355Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9356Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9357@end smallexample
9358
f5c37c66
EZ
9359@noindent
9360This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9361during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9362collect}.
9363
c906108c
SS
9364@kindex info source
9365@item info source
919d772c
JB
9366Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9367the function containing the current point of execution:
9368@itemize @bullet
9369@item
9370the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9371@item
9372the directory it was compiled in,
9373@item
9374its length, in lines,
9375@item
9376which programming language it is written in,
9377@item
9378whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9379if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9380@item
9381whether the debugging information includes information about
9382preprocessor macros.
9383@end itemize
9384
c906108c
SS
9385
9386@kindex info sources
9387@item info sources
9388Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9389debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9390have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9391
9392@kindex info functions
9393@item info functions
9394Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9395
9396@item info functions @var{regexp}
9397Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9398whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9399Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9400include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
9401start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9402that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9403@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
9404
9405@kindex info variables
9406@item info variables
9407Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 9408outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
9409
9410@item info variables @var{regexp}
9411Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9412variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9413@var{regexp}.
9414
9415@ignore
9416This was never implemented.
9417@kindex info methods
9418@item info methods
9419@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9420The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
9421methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9422specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9423C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
9424from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9425@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9426which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9427@end ignore
9428
c906108c
SS
9429@cindex reloading symbols
9430Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
9431be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9432in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9433running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9434@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
9435
9436@table @code
9437@kindex set symbol-reloading
9438@item set symbol-reloading on
9439Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9440object file with a particular name is seen again.
9441
9442@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
9443Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9444same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9445running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9446should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9447may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9448several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9449name.
c906108c
SS
9450
9451@kindex show symbol-reloading
9452@item show symbol-reloading
9453Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9454@end table
c906108c 9455
c906108c
SS
9456@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9457@item set opaque-type-resolution on
9458Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9459declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9460@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9461source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9462another source file. The default is on.
9463
9464A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9465the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9466
9467@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9468Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9469is printed as follows:
9470@smallexample
9471@{<no data fields>@}
9472@end smallexample
9473
9474@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9475@item show opaque-type-resolution
9476Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9477
9478@kindex maint print symbols
9479@cindex symbol dump
9480@kindex maint print psymbols
9481@cindex partial symbol dump
9482@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9483@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9484@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9485Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9486These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9487symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9488symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9489collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9490only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9491command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9492use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9493symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9494files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9495@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9496required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9497@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9498@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9499@end table
9500
6d2ebf8b 9501@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9502@chapter Altering Execution
9503
9504Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9505find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9506correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9507experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9508program.
9509
9510For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9511locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9512address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9513
9514@menu
9515* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9516* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9517* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9518* Returning:: Returning from a function
9519* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9520* Patching:: Patching your program
9521@end menu
9522
6d2ebf8b 9523@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9524@section Assignment to variables
9525
9526@cindex assignment
9527@cindex setting variables
9528To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9529@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9530
474c8240 9531@smallexample
c906108c 9532print x=4
474c8240 9533@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9534
9535@noindent
9536stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9537value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9538@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9539information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9540
9541@kindex set variable
9542@cindex variables, setting
9543If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9544@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9545really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9546not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9547,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9548
c906108c
SS
9549If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9550appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9551variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9552to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9553program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9554a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9555command @code{set width}:
9556
474c8240 9557@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9558(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9559type = double
9560(@value{GDBP}) p width
9561$4 = 13
9562(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9563Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9564@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9565
9566@noindent
9567The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9568order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9569
474c8240 9570@smallexample
c906108c 9571(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9572@end smallexample
53a5351d 9573
c906108c
SS
9574Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9575with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9576@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9577your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9578to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9579the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9580
474c8240 9581@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9582@group
9583(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9584type = double
9585(@value{GDBP}) p g
9586$1 = 1
9587(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9588(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9589$2 = 1
9590(@value{GDBP}) r
9591The program being debugged has been started already.
9592Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9593Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9594"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9595 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9596(@value{GDBP}) show g
9597The current BFD target is "=4".
9598@end group
474c8240 9599@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9600
9601@noindent
9602The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9603@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9604@code{g}, use
9605
474c8240 9606@smallexample
c906108c 9607(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9608@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9609
9610@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9611freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9612and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9613same length or shorter.
9614@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9615@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9616
9617To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9618construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9619(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9620to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9621and representation in memory), and
9622
474c8240 9623@smallexample
c906108c 9624set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9625@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9626
9627@noindent
9628stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9629
6d2ebf8b 9630@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9631@section Continuing at a different address
9632
9633Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9634it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9635an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9636
9637@table @code
9638@kindex jump
9639@item jump @var{linespec}
9640Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9641immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9642source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9643@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9644in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9645breakpoints}.
9646
9647The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9648the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9649register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9650a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9651be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9652of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9653confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9654executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9655well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9656
9657@item jump *@var{address}
9658Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9659@end table
9660
c906108c 9661@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9662On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9663command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9664difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9665changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9666example,
c906108c 9667
474c8240 9668@smallexample
c906108c 9669set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9670@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9671
9672@noindent
9673makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9674address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9675@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9676
9677The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9678up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9679that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9680detail.
9681
c906108c 9682@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9683@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9684@section Giving your program a signal
9685
9686@table @code
9687@kindex signal
9688@item signal @var{signal}
9689Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9690signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9691signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9692SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9693
9694Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9695giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9696a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9697@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9698signal.
9699
9700@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9701after executing the command.
9702@end table
9703@c @end group
9704
9705Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9706@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9707causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9708the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9709passes the signal directly to your program.
9710
c906108c 9711
6d2ebf8b 9712@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9713@section Returning from a function
9714
9715@table @code
9716@cindex returning from a function
9717@kindex return
9718@item return
9719@itemx return @var{expression}
9720You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9721command. If you give an
9722@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9723value.
9724@end table
9725
9726When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9727(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9728discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9729be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9730
9731This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9732frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9733innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9734specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9735of functions.
9736
9737The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9738program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9739returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9740and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9741selected stack frame returns naturally.
9742
6d2ebf8b 9743@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9744@section Calling program functions
9745
9746@cindex calling functions
9747@kindex call
9748@table @code
9749@item call @var{expr}
9750Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9751returned values.
9752@end table
9753
9754You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9755execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9756with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9757is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9758
6d2ebf8b 9759@node Patching
c906108c 9760@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9761
c906108c
SS
9762@cindex patching binaries
9763@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9764@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9765
7a292a7a
SS
9766By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9767executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9768alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9769patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9770
9771If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9772explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9773want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9774repairs.
9775
9776@table @code
9777@kindex set write
9778@item set write on
9779@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9780If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9781core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9782off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9783
9784If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9785@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9786write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9787
9788@item show write
9789@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9790Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9791as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9792@end table
9793
6d2ebf8b 9794@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9795@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9796
7a292a7a
SS
9797@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9798both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9799program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9800@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9801
9802@menu
9803* Files:: Commands to specify files
9804* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9805@end menu
9806
6d2ebf8b 9807@node Files
c906108c 9808@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9809
7a292a7a 9810@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9811@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9812
9813You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9814way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9815@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9816Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9817
9818Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9819@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9820a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9821to specify new files are useful.
9822
9823@table @code
9824@cindex executable file
9825@kindex file
9826@item file @var{filename}
9827Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9828symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9829executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9830directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9831@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9832directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9833to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9834and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9835
6d2ebf8b 9836On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9837@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9838@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9839@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9840descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9841(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9842@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9843for more information.
c906108c
SS
9844
9845@item file
9846@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9847has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9848
9849@kindex exec-file
9850@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9851Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9852in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9853if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9854discard information on the executable file.
9855
9856@kindex symbol-file
9857@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9858Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9859searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9860table and program to run from the same file.
9861
9862@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9863program's symbol table.
9864
5d161b24 9865The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9866of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9867auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9868the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9869the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9870
9871@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9872executing it once.
9873
9874When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9875understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9876generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9877other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9878Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9879using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9880optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9881
9882For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9883using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9884symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9885quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9886details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9887
9888The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9889start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9890occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9891file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9892pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9893warnings and messages}.)
9894
c906108c
SS
9895We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9896symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9897symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9898still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9899in stabs format.
9900
9901@kindex readnow
9902@cindex reading symbols immediately
9903@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9904@kindex mapped
9905@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9906@cindex saving symbol table
9907@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9908@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9909You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9910tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9911load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9912entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9913
c906108c
SS
9914If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9915@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9916cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9917file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9918from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9919than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9920program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9921starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9922
9923You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9924file has all the symbol information for your program.
9925
9926The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9927@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9928than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9929it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9930needed.
9931
9932The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9933@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9934symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9935
9936@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9937@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9938@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9939@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9940@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9941@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9942@c files.
9943
9944@kindex core
9945@kindex core-file
9946@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9947Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9948of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9949address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9950executable file itself for other parts.
9951
9952@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9953to be used.
9954
9955Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9956under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9957wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9958the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9959(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9960
c906108c
SS
9961@kindex add-symbol-file
9962@cindex dynamic linking
9963@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9964@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9965@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9966The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9967information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9968when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9969into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9970address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9971this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9972of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9973section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9974@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9975
9976The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9977originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9978@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9979thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9980instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9981
17d9d558
JB
9982@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9983@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9984@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9985@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9986@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9987Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9988executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9989relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9990information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9991
9992@itemize @bullet
9993@item
9994the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9995that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9996@item
9997every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9998been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9999@item
10000you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
10001provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10002@end itemize
10003
10004@noindent
10005Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
10006relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
10007typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
10008important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
10009procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
10010assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
10011general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
10012relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
10013as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
10014way.
10015
c906108c
SS
10016@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10017
10018You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
10019the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
10020table information for @var{filename}.
10021
10022@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
10023@item add-shared-symbol-file
10024The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
10025operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
10026shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 10027@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 10028
c906108c
SS
10029@kindex section
10030@item section
5d161b24
DB
10031The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
10032the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
10033section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
10034specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
10035separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
10036the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
10037
10038@kindex info files
10039@kindex info target
10040@item info files
10041@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
10042@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
10043current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
10044including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
10045use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
10046command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
10047current ones.
10048
fe95c787
MS
10049@kindex maint info sections
10050@item maint info sections
10051Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
10052is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
10053displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
10054offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
10055@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
10056may be arbitrarily combined):
10057
10058@table @code
10059@item ALLOBJ
10060Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
10061@item @var{sections}
6600abed 10062Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
10063@item @var{section-flags}
10064Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
10065The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
10066@table @code
10067@item ALLOC
10068Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
10069Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
10070@item LOAD
10071Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
10072Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
10073@item RELOC
10074Section needs to be relocated before loading.
10075@item READONLY
10076Section cannot be modified by the child process.
10077@item CODE
10078Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 10079@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
10080Section contains data only (no executable code).
10081@item ROM
10082Section will reside in ROM.
10083@item CONSTRUCTOR
10084Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
10085@item HAS_CONTENTS
10086Section is not empty.
10087@item NEVER_LOAD
10088An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
10089@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
10090A notification to the linker that the section contains
10091COFF shared library information.
10092@item IS_COMMON
10093Section contains common symbols.
10094@end table
10095@end table
6763aef9
MS
10096@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
10097@item set trust-readonly-sections on
10098Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 10099really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
10100In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
10101out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
10102For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
10103enhancement to debugging performance.
10104
10105The default is off.
10106
10107@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 10108Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
10109the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
10110and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
10111@end table
10112
10113All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
10114as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
10115name and remembers it that way.
10116
c906108c 10117@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
10118@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
10119libraries.
53a5351d 10120
c906108c
SS
10121@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
10122when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
10123(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
10124references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
10125debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
10126
10127On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
10128automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
10129
c906108c
SS
10130@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
10131@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
10132@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
10133
b7209cb4
FF
10134There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
10135symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
10136particularly large or there are many of them.
10137
10138To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
10139commands:
10140
10141@table @code
10142@kindex set auto-solib-add
10143@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
10144If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
10145will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
10146attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
10147informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
10148is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10149@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
10150
10151@kindex show auto-solib-add
10152@item show auto-solib-add
10153Display the current autoloading mode.
10154@end table
10155
10156To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
10157command:
10158
c906108c
SS
10159@table @code
10160@kindex info sharedlibrary
10161@kindex info share
10162@item info share
10163@itemx info sharedlibrary
10164Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
10165
10166@kindex sharedlibrary
10167@kindex share
10168@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
10169@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
10170Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
10171Unix regular expression.
10172As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
10173required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
10174@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
10175loaded.
10176@end table
10177
b7209cb4
FF
10178On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
10179autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
10180reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
10181by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
10182up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
10183wish.
c906108c
SS
10184
10185Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
10186loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
10187@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
10188automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
10189
10190To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
10191
10192@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
10193@kindex set auto-solib-limit
10194@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
10195Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
10196If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
10197symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
10198size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 10199Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 10200@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 10201Mb).
c906108c 10202
b7209cb4
FF
10203@kindex show auto-solib-limit
10204@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
10205Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
10206@end table
c906108c 10207
6d2ebf8b 10208@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
10209@section Errors reading symbol files
10210
10211While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10212such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10213output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10214they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10215debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10216about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10217only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10218times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10219to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10220complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10221messages}).
10222
10223The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10224
10225@table @code
10226@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10227
10228The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10229(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10230error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10231in its outer scope blocks.
10232
10233@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10234the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10235may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10236function.
10237
10238@item block at @var{address} out of order
10239
10240The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10241order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10242do so.
10243
10244@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10245locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10246can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10247@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10248messages}.)
10249
10250@item bad block start address patched
10251
10252The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10253smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10254to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10255
10256@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10257starting on the previous source line.
10258
10259@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10260
10261@cindex foo
10262Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10263larger than the size of the string table.
10264
10265@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10266name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10267with this name.
10268
10269@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10270
7a292a7a
SS
10271The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10272not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10273uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10274
7a292a7a
SS
10275@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10276This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10277are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10278debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10279on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10280and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10281
10282@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10283
7a292a7a 10284@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10285
7a292a7a 10286@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10287The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10288information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10289it.
c906108c
SS
10290
10291@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10292
10293@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10294
c906108c
SS
10295@end table
10296
6d2ebf8b 10297@node Targets
c906108c 10298@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10299
c906108c
SS
10300@cindex debugging target
10301@kindex target
10302
10303A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10304
10305Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10306in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10307you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10308flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10309host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10310realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10311command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10312(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10313
10314@menu
10315* Active Targets:: Active targets
10316* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10317* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10318* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10319* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10320
10321@end menu
10322
6d2ebf8b 10323@node Active Targets
c906108c 10324@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10325
c906108c
SS
10326@cindex stacking targets
10327@cindex active targets
10328@cindex multiple targets
10329
c906108c 10330There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10331executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10332active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10333start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10334a core file.
c906108c
SS
10335
10336For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10337@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10338well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10339@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10340first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10341requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10342are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10343read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10344executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10345
10346When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10347target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10348commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10349an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10350process target is active.
c906108c 10351
7a292a7a
SS
10352Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10353core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10354files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10355the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10356process}).
c906108c 10357
6d2ebf8b 10358@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10359@section Commands for managing targets
10360
10361@table @code
10362@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10363Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10364process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10365facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10366protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10367
10368Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10369typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10370with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10371
10372The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10373after executing the command.
10374
10375@kindex help target
10376@item help target
10377Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10378currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10379(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10380
10381@item help target @var{name}
10382Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10383select it.
10384
10385@kindex set gnutarget
10386@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10387@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10388knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10389a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10390with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10391with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10392
d4f3574e 10393@quotation
c906108c
SS
10394@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10395you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10396@end quotation
c906108c 10397
d4f3574e
SS
10398@noindent
10399@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10400
5d161b24 10401@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10402@item show gnutarget
10403Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10404@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10405@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10406and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10407@end table
10408
c906108c
SS
10409Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10410configuration):
c906108c
SS
10411
10412@table @code
10413@kindex target exec
10414@item target exec @var{program}
10415An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10416@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10417
c906108c
SS
10418@kindex target core
10419@item target core @var{filename}
10420A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10421@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10422
10423@kindex target remote
10424@item target remote @var{dev}
10425Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10426specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10427@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10428supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10429some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10430it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10431
c906108c
SS
10432@kindex target sim
10433@item target sim
2df3850c 10434Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10435In general,
474c8240 10436@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10437 target sim
10438 load
10439 run
474c8240 10440@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10441@noindent
104c1213 10442works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10443drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10444provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10445see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10446Processors}.
10447
c906108c
SS
10448@end table
10449
104c1213 10450Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10451
10452@table @code
10453
c906108c
SS
10454@kindex target nrom
10455@item target nrom @var{dev}
10456NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10457
c906108c
SS
10458@end table
10459
5d161b24 10460Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10461your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10462
10463Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10464once you've successfully established a connection.
10465
10466@table @code
10467
10468@kindex load @var{filename}
10469@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10470Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10471@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10472is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10473on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10474@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10475the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10476
10477If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10478execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10479target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10480
10481The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10482For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10483link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10484specifies a fixed address.
10485@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10486
c906108c
SS
10487@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10488@end table
10489
6d2ebf8b 10490@node Byte Order
c906108c 10491@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10492
c906108c
SS
10493@cindex choosing target byte order
10494@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10495
10496Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10497offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10498orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10499designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10500which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10501@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10502
10503@table @code
10504@kindex set endian big
10505@item set endian big
10506Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10507
10508@kindex set endian little
10509@item set endian little
10510Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10511
10512@kindex set endian auto
10513@item set endian auto
10514Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10515executable.
10516
10517@item show endian
10518Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10519
10520@end table
10521
10522Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10523data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10524target system.
10525
6d2ebf8b 10526@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10527@section Remote debugging
10528@cindex remote debugging
10529
10530If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10531@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10532For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10533or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10534powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10535
10536Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10537to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10538@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10539but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10540write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10541communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10542
10543Other remote targets may be available in your
10544configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10545
6f05cf9f
AC
10546@node KOD
10547@section Kernel Object Display
10548
10549@cindex kernel object display
10550@cindex kernel object
10551@cindex KOD
10552
10553Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10554@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10555and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10556mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10557displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10558
10559Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10560@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10561
474c8240 10562@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10563(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10564@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10565
10566If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10567about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10568which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10569after the operating system:
c906108c 10570
474c8240 10571@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10572(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10573List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10574Object Description
10575any Any and all objects
474c8240 10576@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10577
10578Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10579by the kernel.
10580
10581There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10582is supported other than to try it.
10583
10584
10585@node Remote Debugging
10586@chapter Debugging remote programs
10587
6b2f586d
AC
10588@menu
10589* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10590* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10591* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10592@end menu
10593
6f05cf9f
AC
10594@node Server
10595@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10596
10597@kindex gdbserver
10598@cindex remote connection without stubs
10599@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10600allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10601@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10602
10603@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10604because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10605that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10606@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10607@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10608because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10609also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10610started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10611Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10612the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10613do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10614by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10615choice for debugging.
10616
10617@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10618or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10619protocol.
10620
10621@table @emph
10622@item On the target machine,
10623you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10624@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10625strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10626system does all the symbol handling.
10627
10628To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10629the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10630syntax is:
10631
10632@smallexample
10633target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10634@end smallexample
10635
10636@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10637hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10638@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10639@file{/dev/com1}:
10640
10641@smallexample
10642target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10643@end smallexample
10644
10645@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10646with it.
10647
10648To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10649
10650@smallexample
10651target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10652@end smallexample
10653
10654The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10655specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10656TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10657expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10658(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10659you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10660TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10661reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10662conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10663and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10664@code{target remote} command.
10665
56460a61
DJ
10666On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10667This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10668
10669@smallexample
10670target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10671@end smallexample
10672
10673@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10674to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10675
6f05cf9f
AC
10676@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10677you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10678symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10679using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10680(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10681running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10682remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10683is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10684@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10685@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10686
10687@smallexample
10688(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10689@end smallexample
10690
10691@noindent
10692communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10693
10694@smallexample
10695(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10696@end smallexample
10697
10698@noindent
10699communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10700For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10701the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10702text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10703@samp{Connection refused}.
10704@end table
10705
10706@node NetWare
10707@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10708
10709@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10710@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10711allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10712@code{target remote}.
10713
10714@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10715using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10716
10717@table @emph
10718@item On the target machine,
10719you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10720@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10721can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10722host system does all the symbol handling.
10723
10724To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10725@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10726program. The syntax is:
10727
10728@smallexample
10729load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10730 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10731@end smallexample
10732
10733@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10734the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10735to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10736
10737For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10738communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10739using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10740
10741@smallexample
10742load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10743@end smallexample
10744
10745@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10746you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10747symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10748using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10749(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10750running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10751remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10752argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10753@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10754
10755@smallexample
10756(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10757@end smallexample
10758
10759@noindent
10760communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10761@end table
10762
10763@node remote stub
10764@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10765
8e04817f
AC
10766@cindex debugging stub, example
10767@cindex remote stub, example
10768@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10769The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10770communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10771@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10772these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10773implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10774with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10775organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10776
104c1213
JM
10777@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10778To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10779@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10780prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10781program, you need:
c906108c 10782
104c1213
JM
10783@enumerate
10784@item
10785A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10786have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10787your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10788
5d161b24 10789@item
d4f3574e 10790A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10791subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10792
104c1213
JM
10793@item
10794A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10795download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10796manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10797documentation.
10798@end enumerate
96baa820 10799
104c1213
JM
10800The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10801communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10802machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10803
104c1213
JM
10804@table @emph
10805@item On the host,
10806@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10807else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10808(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10809
10810@item On the target,
10811you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10812implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10813subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10814
10815On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10816@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10817@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10818@end table
96baa820 10819
104c1213
JM
10820The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10821machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10822@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10823
104c1213
JM
10824@cindex remote serial stub list
10825These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10826
104c1213
JM
10827@table @code
10828
10829@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10830@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10831@cindex Intel
10832@cindex i386
10833For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10834
10835@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10836@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10837@cindex Motorola 680x0
10838@cindex m680x0
10839For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10840
10841@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10842@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10843@cindex Hitachi
10844@cindex SH
10845For Hitachi SH architectures.
10846
10847@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10848@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10849@cindex Sparc
10850For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10851
10852@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10853@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10854@cindex Fujitsu
10855@cindex SparcLite
10856For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10857
10858@end table
10859
10860The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10861recently added stubs.
10862
10863@menu
10864* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10865* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10866* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10867@end menu
10868
6d2ebf8b 10869@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10870@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10871
10872@cindex remote serial stub
10873The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10874subroutines:
10875
10876@table @code
10877@item set_debug_traps
10878@kindex set_debug_traps
10879@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10880This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10881program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10882beginning of your program.
10883
10884@item handle_exception
10885@kindex handle_exception
10886@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10887This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10888explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10889run when a trap is triggered.
10890
10891@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10892execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10893with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10894protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10895representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10896information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10897retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10898execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10899@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10900machine.
104c1213
JM
10901
10902@item breakpoint
10903@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10904Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10905breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10906way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10907machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10908pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10909@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10910simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10911again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10912your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10913@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10914
10915Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10916to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10917start of your debugging session.
10918@end table
10919
6d2ebf8b 10920@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10921@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10922
10923@cindex remote stub, support routines
10924The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10925chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10926debugging target machine.
10927
10928First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10929serial port.
10930
10931@table @code
10932@item int getDebugChar()
10933@kindex getDebugChar
10934Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10935It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10936different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10937
10938@item void putDebugChar(int)
10939@kindex putDebugChar
10940Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10941It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10942different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10943@end table
10944
10945@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10946@cindex interrupting remote targets
10947If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10948running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10949for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10950character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10951remote system to stop.
10952
10953Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10954probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10955is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10956@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10957
10958Other routines you need to supply are:
10959
10960@table @code
10961@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10962@kindex exceptionHandler
10963Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10964handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10965way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10966are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10967containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10968@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10969its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10970might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10971exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10972@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10973and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10974you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10975should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10976
10977For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10978gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10979should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10980@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10981help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10982
10983@item void flush_i_cache()
10984@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10985On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10986instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10987instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10988
10989On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10990function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10991@end table
10992
10993@noindent
10994You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10995
10996@table @code
10997@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10998@kindex memset
10999This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
11000memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
11001@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11002either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11003@end table
11004
11005If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11006library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11007but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 11008subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
11009
11010
6d2ebf8b 11011@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 11012@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
11013
11014@cindex remote serial debugging summary
11015In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11016steps.
11017
11018@enumerate
11019@item
6d2ebf8b 11020Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
11021(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11022@display
11023@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11024@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11025@end display
11026
11027@item
11028Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11029
474c8240 11030@smallexample
104c1213
JM
11031set_debug_traps();
11032breakpoint();
474c8240 11033@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11034
11035@item
11036For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11037@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11038
474c8240 11039@smallexample
104c1213 11040void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 11041@end smallexample
104c1213 11042
d4f3574e 11043@noindent
104c1213 11044but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 11045function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
11046@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11047error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11048one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11049
11050@item
11051Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11052your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11053
11054@item
11055Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11056the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11057
11058@item
11059@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11060@c document that. FIXME.
11061Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11062whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11063
11064@item
11065To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
11066as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
11067This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
11068of its pure text.
11069
d4f3574e 11070@item
104c1213 11071@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 11072Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
11073Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
11074machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 11075TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
11076to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
11077device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
11078
474c8240 11079@smallexample
104c1213 11080target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 11081@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11082
11083@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
11084To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
11085@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
11086For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
11087terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11088
474c8240 11089@smallexample
104c1213 11090target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 11091@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
11092
11093If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
11094your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
11095the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
11096to port 1234 on your local machine:
11097
474c8240 11098@smallexample
a2bea4c3 11099target remote :1234
474c8240 11100@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
11101@noindent
11102
11103Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
11104
11105@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
11106To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
11107@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
11108on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11109
11110@smallexample
11111target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
11112@end smallexample
11113
11114When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
11115that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
11116busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
11117session.
11118
104c1213
JM
11119@end enumerate
11120
11121Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
11122step and continue the remote program.
11123
11124To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
11125command.
11126
11127@cindex interrupting remote programs
11128@cindex remote programs, interrupting
11129Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
11130interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
11131program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
11132and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
11133interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
11134
474c8240 11135@smallexample
104c1213
JM
11136Interrupted while waiting for the program.
11137Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 11138@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11139
11140If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
11141(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
11142remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
11143goes back to waiting.
11144
104c1213 11145
8e04817f
AC
11146@node Configurations
11147@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 11148
8e04817f
AC
11149While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11150cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11151describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 11152
8e04817f
AC
11153There are three major categories of configurations: native
11154configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11155operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11156different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11157are quite different from each other.
104c1213 11158
8e04817f
AC
11159@menu
11160* Native::
11161* Embedded OS::
11162* Embedded Processors::
11163* Architectures::
11164@end menu
104c1213 11165
8e04817f
AC
11166@node Native
11167@section Native
104c1213 11168
8e04817f
AC
11169This section describes details specific to particular native
11170configurations.
6cf7e474 11171
8e04817f
AC
11172@menu
11173* HP-UX:: HP-UX
11174* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11175* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 11176* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 11177@end menu
6cf7e474 11178
8e04817f
AC
11179@node HP-UX
11180@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 11181
8e04817f
AC
11182On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11183begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11184name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 11185
8e04817f
AC
11186@node SVR4 Process Information
11187@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 11188
8e04817f
AC
11189@kindex /proc
11190@cindex process image
104c1213 11191
8e04817f
AC
11192Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11193used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11194subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11195this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11196several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11197@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11198@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11199and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
104c1213 11200
8e04817f
AC
11201@table @code
11202@kindex info proc
11203@item info proc
11204Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 11205
8e04817f
AC
11206@kindex info proc mappings
11207@item info proc mappings
11208Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11209on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11210@ignore
11211@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11212@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11213@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11214@kindex info proc times
11215@item info proc times
11216Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11217its children.
6cf7e474 11218
8e04817f
AC
11219@kindex info proc id
11220@item info proc id
11221Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11222the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 11223
8e04817f
AC
11224@kindex info proc status
11225@item info proc status
11226General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11227stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11228received.
d4f3574e 11229
8e04817f
AC
11230@item info proc all
11231Show all the above information about the process.
11232@end ignore
11233@end table
104c1213 11234
8e04817f
AC
11235@node DJGPP Native
11236@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11237@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11238@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11239@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 11240
8e04817f
AC
11241@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11242MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11243that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11244top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 11245
8e04817f
AC
11246@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11247defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11248subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 11249
8e04817f
AC
11250@table @code
11251@kindex info dos
11252@item info dos
11253This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11254information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11255
8e04817f
AC
11256@kindex sysinfo
11257@cindex MS-DOS system info
11258@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11259@item info dos sysinfo
11260This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11261platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11262DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11263
8e04817f
AC
11264@cindex GDT
11265@cindex LDT
11266@cindex IDT
11267@cindex segment descriptor tables
11268@cindex descriptor tables display
11269@item info dos gdt
11270@itemx info dos ldt
11271@itemx info dos idt
11272These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11273and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11274tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11275that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11276descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11277descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11278rights.
104c1213 11279
8e04817f
AC
11280A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11281segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11282allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11283conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11284additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11285
8e04817f
AC
11286@cindex garbled pointers
11287These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11288Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11289displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11290display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11291example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11292debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11293
8e04817f
AC
11294@smallexample
11295@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11296@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11297@end smallexample
104c1213 11298
8e04817f
AC
11299@noindent
11300This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11301the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11302
8e04817f
AC
11303@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11304@item info dos pde
11305@itemx info dos pte
11306These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11307Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11308data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11309into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11310page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11311may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11312Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11313that is currently in use.
104c1213 11314
8e04817f
AC
11315Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11316Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11317the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11318@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11319Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11320means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11321the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11322
8e04817f
AC
11323@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11324These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11325Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11326controller.
104c1213 11327
8e04817f 11328These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11329
8e04817f
AC
11330@cindex physical address from linear address
11331@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11332This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11333address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11334appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11335accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11336example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11337the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11338
8e04817f
AC
11339@smallexample
11340@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11341@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11342@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11343@end smallexample
104c1213 11344
8e04817f
AC
11345@noindent
11346This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11347whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11348attributes of that page.
104c1213 11349
8e04817f
AC
11350Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11351since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11352address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11353be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11354declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11355@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11356
8e04817f
AC
11357Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11358transfer buffer:
104c1213 11359
8e04817f
AC
11360@smallexample
11361@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11362@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11363@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11364@end smallexample
104c1213 11365
8e04817f
AC
11366@noindent
11367(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
113683rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11369this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11370mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11371
8e04817f
AC
11372This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11373@end table
104c1213 11374
78c47bea
PM
11375@node Cygwin Native
11376@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11377@cindex MS Windows debugging
11378@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11379@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11380
11381@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
11382defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
11383subsection describes those commands.
11384
11385@table @code
11386@kindex info w32
11387@item info w32
11388This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11389information about the target system and important OS structures.
11390
11391@item info w32 selector
11392This command displays information returned by
11393the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11394It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11395a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11396Without argument, this command displays information
11397about the the six segment registers.
11398
11399@kindex info dll
11400@item info dll
11401This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11402
11403@kindex dll-symbols
11404@item dll-symbols
11405This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11406add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11407
11408@kindex set new-console
11409@item set new-console @var{mode}
11410If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11411be started in a new console on next start.
11412If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11413be started in the same console as the debugger.
11414
11415@kindex show new-console
11416@item show new-console
11417Displays whether a new console is used
11418when the debuggee is started.
11419
11420@kindex set new-group
11421@item set new-group @var{mode}
11422This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11423start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11424This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11425Ctrl-C.
11426
11427@kindex show new-group
11428@item show new-group
11429Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11430
11431@kindex set debugevents
11432@item set debugevents
11433This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11434
11435@kindex set debugexec
11436@item set debugexec
11437This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11438seen by the debugger.
11439
11440@kindex set debugexceptions
11441@item set debugexceptions
11442This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11443seen by the debugger.
11444
11445@kindex set debugmemory
11446@item set debugmemory
11447This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11448seen by the debugger.
11449
11450@kindex set shell
11451@item set shell
11452This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11453via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11454
11455@kindex show shell
11456@item show shell
11457Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11458
11459@end table
11460
8e04817f
AC
11461@node Embedded OS
11462@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11463
8e04817f
AC
11464This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11465embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11466architectures.
d4f3574e 11467
8e04817f
AC
11468@menu
11469* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11470@end menu
104c1213 11471
8e04817f
AC
11472@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11473various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11474
8e04817f
AC
11475@node VxWorks
11476@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11477
8e04817f 11478@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11479
8e04817f 11480@table @code
104c1213 11481
8e04817f
AC
11482@kindex target vxworks
11483@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11484A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11485is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11486
8e04817f 11487@end table
104c1213 11488
8e04817f
AC
11489On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11490current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11491
8e04817f
AC
11492@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11493VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11494the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11495both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11496@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11497installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11498@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11499
8e04817f
AC
11500@table @code
11501@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11502@kindex vxworks-timeout
11503All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11504This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11505seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11506your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11507of a thin network line.
11508@end table
104c1213 11509
8e04817f
AC
11510The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11511this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11512procedures.
104c1213 11513
8e04817f
AC
11514@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11515To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11516to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11517library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11518VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11519kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11520source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11521information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11522manual.
11523@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11524
8e04817f
AC
11525Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11526your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11527run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11528@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11529
8e04817f 11530@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11531
474c8240 11532@smallexample
8e04817f 11533(vxgdb)
474c8240 11534@end smallexample
104c1213 11535
8e04817f
AC
11536@menu
11537* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11538* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11539* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11540@end menu
104c1213 11541
8e04817f
AC
11542@node VxWorks Connection
11543@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11544
8e04817f
AC
11545The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11546network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11547
474c8240 11548@smallexample
8e04817f 11549(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11550@end smallexample
104c1213 11551
8e04817f
AC
11552@need 750
11553@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11554
8e04817f
AC
11555@smallexample
11556Attaching remote machine across net...
11557Connected to tt.
11558@end smallexample
104c1213 11559
8e04817f
AC
11560@need 1000
11561@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11562loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11563these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11564path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11565to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11566
474c8240 11567@smallexample
8e04817f 11568prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11569@end smallexample
104c1213 11570
8e04817f
AC
11571When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11572the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11573command again.
104c1213 11574
8e04817f
AC
11575@node VxWorks Download
11576@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11577
8e04817f
AC
11578@cindex download to VxWorks
11579If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11580object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11581@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11582incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11583command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11584to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11585table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11586the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11587filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11588Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11589to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11590the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11591@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11592and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11593program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11594
474c8240 11595@smallexample
8e04817f 11596-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11597@end smallexample
104c1213 11598
8e04817f
AC
11599@noindent
11600Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11601
474c8240 11602@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11603(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11604(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11605@end smallexample
104c1213 11606
8e04817f 11607@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11608
8e04817f
AC
11609@smallexample
11610Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11611@end smallexample
104c1213 11612
8e04817f
AC
11613You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11614after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11615this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11616auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11617history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11618debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11619table.)
104c1213 11620
8e04817f
AC
11621@node VxWorks Attach
11622@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11623
11624@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11625You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11626follows:
11627
474c8240 11628@smallexample
104c1213 11629(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11630@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11631
11632@noindent
11633where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11634or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11635the time of attachment.
11636
6d2ebf8b 11637@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11638@section Embedded Processors
11639
11640This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11641configurations.
11642
7d86b5d5 11643
104c1213 11644@menu
104c1213
JM
11645* ARM:: ARM
11646* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11647* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11648* i960:: Intel i960
11649* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11650* M68K:: Motorola M68K
7fb623f7 11651@c OBSOLETE * M88K:: Motorola M88K
104c1213
JM
11652* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11653* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11654* PowerPC: PowerPC
11655* SH:: Hitachi SH
11656* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11657* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11658* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11659* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11660@end menu
11661
6d2ebf8b 11662@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11663@subsection ARM
11664
11665@table @code
11666
8e04817f
AC
11667@kindex target rdi
11668@item target rdi @var{dev}
11669ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11670use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11671monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11672
11673@kindex target rdp
11674@item target rdp @var{dev}
11675ARM Demon monitor.
11676
11677@end table
11678
11679@node H8/300
11680@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11681
11682@table @code
11683
11684@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11685@item target hms @var{dev}
11686A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11687Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11688line and the communications speed used.
11689
11690@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11691@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11692E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11693
11694@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11695@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11696@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11697@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11698Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11699
11700@end table
11701
11702@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11703@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11704@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11705@cindex Hitachi SH download
11706When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11707board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11708board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11709@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11710
11711@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11712Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11713
11714@enumerate
11715@item
11716that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11717for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11718emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11719the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11720H8/300, or H8/500.)
11721
11722@item
11723what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11724serial device available on your host is the default).
11725
11726@item
11727what speed to use over the serial device.
11728@end enumerate
11729
11730@menu
11731* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11732* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11733* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11734@end menu
11735
11736@node Hitachi Boards
11737@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11738
11739@c only for Unix hosts
11740@kindex device
11741@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11742Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11743need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11744first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11745hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11746
11747@kindex speed
11748@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11749@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11750speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11751hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11752the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11753@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11754
11755The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11756use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11757use a DOS host,
11758@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11759called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11760through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11761to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11762
11763The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11764program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11765sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11766the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11767
11768First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11769board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11770port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11771When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11772debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11773for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11774@code{COM2}.
11775
474c8240 11776@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11777C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11778C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11779
11780Resident portion of MODE loaded
11781
11782COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11783
474c8240 11784@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11785
11786@quotation
11787@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11788@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11789disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11790your development board.
11791@end quotation
11792
11793@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11794Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11795connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11796the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11797you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11798commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11799cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11800download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11801the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11802(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11803executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11804@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11805itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11806
11807@smallexample
11808(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11809@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11810 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11811 the conditions.
11812There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11813for details.
11814@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11815(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11816Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11817(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11818.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11819.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11820.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11821@end smallexample
11822
11823At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11824you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11825sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11826@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11827resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11828@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11829
11830Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11831available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11832you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11833
11834Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11835@itemize @bullet
11836@item
11837to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11838no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11839
11840@item
11841to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11842normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11843to detect program completion.
11844@end itemize
11845
11846In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11847development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11848
11849@node Hitachi ICE
11850@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11851
11852@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11853You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11854Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11855e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11856
11857@table @code
11858@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11859Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11860@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11861@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11862(for example, @samp{9600}).
11863
11864@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11865If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11866specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11867@end table
11868
11869@node Hitachi Special
11870@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11871
11872Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11873
11874@table @code
11875
11876@kindex set machine
11877@kindex show machine
11878@item set machine h8300
11879@itemx set machine h8300h
11880Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11881architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11882to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11883
11884@end table
11885
8e04817f
AC
11886@node H8/500
11887@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11888
11889@table @code
11890
8e04817f
AC
11891@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11892@cindex memory models, H8/500
11893@item set memory @var{mod}
11894@itemx show memory
11895Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11896@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11897memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11898@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11899
8e04817f 11900@end table
104c1213 11901
8e04817f
AC
11902@node i960
11903@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11904
8e04817f 11905@table @code
104c1213 11906
8e04817f
AC
11907@kindex target mon960
11908@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11909MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11910
8e04817f
AC
11911@kindex target nindy
11912@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11913An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11914the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11915@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11916
8e04817f
AC
11917@end table
11918
11919@cindex Nindy
11920@cindex i960
11921@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11922@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11923tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11924
11925@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11926@item
8e04817f
AC
11927Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11928Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11929
11930@item
8e04817f 11931By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11932
11933@item
8e04817f
AC
11934By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11935session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11936
11937@end itemize
11938
11939@cindex download to Nindy-960
11940With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11941downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11942@value{GDBN}.
11943
11944@menu
11945* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11946* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11947* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11948@end menu
11949
11950@node Nindy Startup
11951@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11952
11953If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11954options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11955reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11956
474c8240 11957@smallexample
8e04817f 11958Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11959@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11960
11961@noindent
11962Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11963identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11964simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11965with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11966use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11967
11968@node Nindy Options
11969@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11970
11971These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11972Nindy-960 board attached:
11973
11974@table @code
11975@item -r @var{port}
11976Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11977to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11978configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11979@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11980device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11981suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11982
11983@item -O
11984(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11985the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11986This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11987target architecture.
11988
11989@quotation
11990@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11991connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11992fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11993attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11994this process with an interrupt.
11995@end quotation
11996
11997@item -brk
11998Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11999system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
12000
12001@quotation
12002@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
12003requires; it only works with a few boards.
12004@end quotation
12005@end table
12006
12007The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
12008port.
12009
12010@c @group
12011@node Nindy Reset
12012@subsubsection Nindy reset command
12013
12014@table @code
12015@item reset
12016@kindex reset
12017For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
12018system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
12019circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
12020a break is detected.
12021@end table
12022@c @end group
12023
12024@node M32R/D
12025@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
12026
12027@table @code
12028
12029@kindex target m32r
12030@item target m32r @var{dev}
12031Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
12032
12033@end table
12034
12035@node M68K
12036@subsection M68k
12037
12038The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12039target command for the following ROM monitors.
12040
12041@table @code
12042
12043@kindex target abug
12044@item target abug @var{dev}
12045ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12046
12047@kindex target cpu32bug
12048@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12049CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12050
12051@kindex target dbug
12052@item target dbug @var{dev}
12053dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12054
12055@kindex target est
12056@item target est @var{dev}
12057EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12058
12059@kindex target rom68k
12060@item target rom68k @var{dev}
12061ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12062
12063@end table
12064
12065If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
12066instead have only a single special target command:
12067
12068@table @code
12069
12070@kindex target es1800
12071@item target es1800 @var{dev}
12072ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
12073
12074@end table
12075
12076[context?]
12077
12078@table @code
12079
12080@kindex target rombug
12081@item target rombug @var{dev}
12082ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12083
12084@end table
12085
7fb623f7
AC
12086@c OBSOLETE @node M88K
12087@c OBSOLETE @subsection M88K
12088@c OBSOLETE
12089@c OBSOLETE @table @code
12090@c OBSOLETE
12091@c OBSOLETE @kindex target bug
12092@c OBSOLETE @item target bug @var{dev}
12093@c OBSOLETE BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
12094@c OBSOLETE
12095@c OBSOLETE @end table
8e04817f
AC
12096
12097@node MIPS Embedded
12098@subsection MIPS Embedded
12099
12100@cindex MIPS boards
12101@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12102MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12103you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 12104
8e04817f
AC
12105@need 1000
12106Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 12107
8e04817f
AC
12108@table @code
12109@item target mips @var{port}
12110@kindex target mips @var{port}
12111To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12112name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12113command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12114the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12115been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12116download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 12117
8e04817f
AC
12118For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12119port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12120debugger:
104c1213 12121
474c8240 12122@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12123host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12124@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12125(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12126(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12127(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 12128@end smallexample
104c1213 12129
8e04817f
AC
12130@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12131On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12132connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12133concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12134@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12135
8e04817f
AC
12136@item target pmon @var{port}
12137@kindex target pmon @var{port}
12138PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 12139
8e04817f
AC
12140@item target ddb @var{port}
12141@kindex target ddb @var{port}
12142NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 12143
8e04817f
AC
12144@item target lsi @var{port}
12145@kindex target lsi @var{port}
12146LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 12147
8e04817f
AC
12148@kindex target r3900
12149@item target r3900 @var{dev}
12150Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 12151
8e04817f
AC
12152@kindex target array
12153@item target array @var{dev}
12154Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 12155
8e04817f 12156@end table
104c1213 12157
104c1213 12158
8e04817f
AC
12159@noindent
12160@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 12161
8e04817f
AC
12162@table @code
12163@item set processor @var{args}
12164@itemx show processor
12165@kindex set processor @var{args}
12166@kindex show processor
12167Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12168processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12169For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12170to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12171Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12172is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12173@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 12174
8e04817f
AC
12175@item set mipsfpu double
12176@itemx set mipsfpu single
12177@itemx set mipsfpu none
12178@itemx show mipsfpu
12179@kindex set mipsfpu
12180@kindex show mipsfpu
12181@cindex MIPS remote floating point
12182@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12183If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12184coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12185need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12186file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12187functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12188@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12189functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12190with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12191processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12192double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12193@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 12194
8e04817f
AC
12195In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12196floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12197and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 12198
8e04817f
AC
12199As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12200@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 12201
8e04817f
AC
12202@item set remotedebug @var{n}
12203@itemx show remotedebug
12204@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12205@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12206@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12207@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12208@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12209@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12210You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12211by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12212@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12213to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12214at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 12215
8e04817f
AC
12216@item set timeout @var{seconds}
12217@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12218@itemx show timeout
12219@itemx show retransmit-timeout
12220@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12221@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12222@kindex set timeout
12223@kindex show timeout
12224@kindex set retransmit-timeout
12225@kindex show retransmit-timeout
12226You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12227remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12228default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12229waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12230retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12231You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12232retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12233@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 12234
8e04817f
AC
12235The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12236is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12237forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12238to run before stopping.
12239@end table
104c1213 12240
8e04817f
AC
12241@node PowerPC
12242@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12243
12244@table @code
104c1213 12245
8e04817f
AC
12246@kindex target dink32
12247@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12248DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 12249
8e04817f
AC
12250@kindex target ppcbug
12251@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12252@kindex target ppcbug1
12253@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12254PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 12255
8e04817f
AC
12256@kindex target sds
12257@item target sds @var{dev}
12258SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12259
12260@end table
12261
12262@node PA
12263@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12264
12265@table @code
12266
8e04817f
AC
12267@kindex target op50n
12268@item target op50n @var{dev}
12269OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12270
12271@kindex target w89k
12272@item target w89k @var{dev}
12273W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12274
12275@end table
12276
8e04817f
AC
12277@node SH
12278@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
12279
12280@table @code
12281
8e04817f
AC
12282@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12283@item target hms @var{dev}
12284A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12285commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12286the communications speed used.
104c1213 12287
8e04817f
AC
12288@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12289@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12290E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 12291
8e04817f
AC
12292@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12293@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12294@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12295@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12296Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12297
8e04817f 12298@end table
104c1213 12299
8e04817f
AC
12300@node Sparclet
12301@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12302
8e04817f
AC
12303@cindex Sparclet
12304
12305@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12306Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12307@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12308both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12309@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12310
8e04817f
AC
12311@table @code
12312@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12313@kindex remotetimeout
12314@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12315This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12316seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12317@end table
12318
8e04817f
AC
12319@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12320When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12321information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12322load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12323@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12324
474c8240 12325@smallexample
8e04817f 12326sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12327@end smallexample
104c1213 12328
8e04817f 12329You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12330
474c8240 12331@smallexample
8e04817f 12332sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12333@end smallexample
104c1213 12334
8e04817f
AC
12335@cindex running, on Sparclet
12336Once you have set
12337your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12338run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12339(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12340
8e04817f
AC
12341@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12342
474c8240 12343@smallexample
8e04817f 12344(gdbslet)
474c8240 12345@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12346
12347@menu
8e04817f
AC
12348* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12349* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12350* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12351* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12352@end menu
12353
8e04817f
AC
12354@node Sparclet File
12355@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12356
8e04817f 12357The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12358
474c8240 12359@smallexample
8e04817f 12360(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12361@end smallexample
104c1213 12362
8e04817f
AC
12363@need 1000
12364@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12365@value{GDBN} locates
12366the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12367path.
12368If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12369files will be searched as well.
12370@value{GDBN} locates
12371the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12372path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12373If it fails
12374to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12375
474c8240 12376@smallexample
8e04817f 12377prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12378@end smallexample
104c1213 12379
8e04817f
AC
12380When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12381the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12382@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12383
8e04817f
AC
12384@node Sparclet Connection
12385@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12386
8e04817f
AC
12387The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12388To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12389
474c8240 12390@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12391(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12392Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12393main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12394@end smallexample
104c1213 12395
8e04817f
AC
12396@need 750
12397@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12398
474c8240 12399@smallexample
8e04817f 12400Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12401@end smallexample
104c1213 12402
8e04817f
AC
12403@node Sparclet Download
12404@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12405
8e04817f
AC
12406@cindex download to Sparclet
12407Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12408you can use the @value{GDBN}
12409@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12410The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12411command.
12412Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12413address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12414offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12415of each of the file's sections.
12416For instance, if the program
12417@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12418and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12419
474c8240 12420@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12421(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12422Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12423@end smallexample
104c1213 12424
8e04817f
AC
12425If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12426to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12427to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12428
12429@node Sparclet Execution
12430@subsubsection Running and debugging
12431
12432@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12433You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12434commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12435manual for the list of commands.
12436
474c8240 12437@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12438(gdbslet) b main
12439Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12440(gdbslet) run
12441Starting program: prog
12442Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
124433 char *symarg = 0;
12444(gdbslet) step
124454 char *execarg = "hello!";
12446(gdbslet)
474c8240 12447@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12448
12449@node Sparclite
12450@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12451
12452@table @code
12453
8e04817f
AC
12454@kindex target sparclite
12455@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12456Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12457You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12458For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12459remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12460
12461@end table
12462
8e04817f
AC
12463@node ST2000
12464@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12465
8e04817f
AC
12466@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12467STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12468
8e04817f
AC
12469To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12470manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12471
474c8240 12472@smallexample
8e04817f 12473target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12474@end smallexample
104c1213 12475
8e04817f
AC
12476@noindent
12477to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12478the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12479ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12480connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12481concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12482
8e04817f
AC
12483The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12484this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12485would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12486(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12487available on your host computer.
12488@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12489@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12490
8e04817f
AC
12491@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12492These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12493environment:
104c1213 12494
8e04817f
AC
12495@table @code
12496@item st2000 @var{command}
12497@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12498@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12499@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12500Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12501manual for available commands.
104c1213 12502
8e04817f
AC
12503@item connect
12504@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12505Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12506you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12507sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12508@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12509@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12510@end table
12511
8e04817f
AC
12512@node Z8000
12513@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12514
8e04817f
AC
12515@cindex Z8000
12516@cindex simulator, Z8000
12517@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12518
8e04817f
AC
12519When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12520a Z8000 simulator.
12521
12522For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12523unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12524segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12525appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12526
8e04817f
AC
12527@table @code
12528@item target sim @var{args}
12529@kindex sim
12530@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12531Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12532options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12533@end table
12534
8e04817f
AC
12535@noindent
12536After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12537CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12538@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12539to run your program, and so on.
12540
12541As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12542(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12543additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12544
12545@table @code
12546
8e04817f
AC
12547@item cycles
12548Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12549
8e04817f
AC
12550@item insts
12551Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12552
8e04817f
AC
12553@item time
12554Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12555
8e04817f 12556@end table
104c1213 12557
8e04817f
AC
12558You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12559conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12560conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12561simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12562
8e04817f
AC
12563@node Architectures
12564@section Architectures
104c1213 12565
8e04817f
AC
12566This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12567all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12568
8e04817f
AC
12569@menu
12570* A29K::
12571* Alpha::
12572* MIPS::
12573@end menu
104c1213 12574
8e04817f
AC
12575@node A29K
12576@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12577
12578@table @code
104c1213 12579
8e04817f
AC
12580@kindex set rstack_high_address
12581@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12582@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12583@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12584On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12585@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12586extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12587stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12588memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12589this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12590the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12591address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12592hexadecimal.
104c1213 12593
8e04817f
AC
12594@kindex show rstack_high_address
12595@item show rstack_high_address
12596Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12597processors.
104c1213 12598
8e04817f 12599@end table
104c1213 12600
8e04817f
AC
12601@node Alpha
12602@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12603
8e04817f 12604See the following section.
104c1213 12605
8e04817f
AC
12606@node MIPS
12607@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12608
8e04817f
AC
12609@cindex stack on Alpha
12610@cindex stack on MIPS
12611@cindex Alpha stack
12612@cindex MIPS stack
12613Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12614sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12615find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12616
8e04817f
AC
12617@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12618To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12619@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12620you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12621commands:
104c1213 12622
8e04817f
AC
12623@table @code
12624@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12625@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12626Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12627search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12628default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12629larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12630and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12631
8e04817f
AC
12632@item show heuristic-fence-post
12633Display the current limit.
12634@end table
104c1213
JM
12635
12636@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12637These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12638for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12639
104c1213 12640
8e04817f
AC
12641@node Controlling GDB
12642@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12643
12644You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12645@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12646data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12647described here.
12648
12649@menu
12650* Prompt:: Prompt
12651* Editing:: Command editing
12652* History:: Command history
12653* Screen Size:: Screen size
12654* Numbers:: Numbers
12655* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12656* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12657@end menu
12658
12659@node Prompt
12660@section Prompt
104c1213 12661
8e04817f 12662@cindex prompt
104c1213 12663
8e04817f
AC
12664@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12665called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12666can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12667instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12668the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12669which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12670
8e04817f
AC
12671@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12672prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12673or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12674
8e04817f
AC
12675@table @code
12676@kindex set prompt
12677@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12678Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12679
8e04817f
AC
12680@kindex show prompt
12681@item show prompt
12682Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12683@end table
12684
8e04817f
AC
12685@node Editing
12686@section Command editing
12687@cindex readline
12688@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12689
8e04817f
AC
12690@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12691@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12692command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12693or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12694substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12695debugging sessions.
104c1213 12696
8e04817f
AC
12697You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12698command @code{set}.
104c1213 12699
8e04817f
AC
12700@table @code
12701@kindex set editing
12702@cindex editing
12703@item set editing
12704@itemx set editing on
12705Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12706
8e04817f
AC
12707@item set editing off
12708Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12709
8e04817f
AC
12710@kindex show editing
12711@item show editing
12712Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12713@end table
12714
8e04817f
AC
12715@node History
12716@section Command history
12717
12718@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12719debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12720happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12721history facility.
104c1213
JM
12722
12723@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12724@cindex history substitution
12725@cindex history file
12726@kindex set history filename
12727@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12728@item set history filename @var{fname}
12729Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12730This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12731list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12732exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12733the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12734to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12735@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12736is not set.
104c1213 12737
8e04817f
AC
12738@cindex history save
12739@kindex set history save
12740@item set history save
12741@itemx set history save on
12742Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12743@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12744
8e04817f
AC
12745@item set history save off
12746Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12747
8e04817f
AC
12748@cindex history size
12749@kindex set history size
12750@item set history size @var{size}
12751Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12752This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12753@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12754@end table
12755
8e04817f
AC
12756@cindex history expansion
12757History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12758@ifset have-readline-appendices
12759@xref{Event Designators}.
12760@end ifset
12761
12762Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12763is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12764@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12765follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12766a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12767history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12768@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12769
12770The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12771
12772@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12773@kindex set history expansion
12774@item set history expansion on
12775@itemx set history expansion
12776Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12777
8e04817f
AC
12778@item set history expansion off
12779Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12780
8e04817f
AC
12781The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12782editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12783or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12784@ifset have-readline-appendices
12785@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12786@end ifset
104c1213 12787
8e04817f
AC
12788@c @group
12789@kindex show history
12790@item show history
12791@itemx show history filename
12792@itemx show history save
12793@itemx show history size
12794@itemx show history expansion
12795These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12796@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12797@c @end group
12798@end table
12799
12800@table @code
12801@kindex shows
12802@item show commands
12803Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12804
8e04817f
AC
12805@item show commands @var{n}
12806Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12807
12808@item show commands +
12809Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12810@end table
12811
8e04817f
AC
12812@node Screen Size
12813@section Screen size
12814@cindex size of screen
12815@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12816
8e04817f
AC
12817Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12818information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12819@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12820output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12821to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12822determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12823printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12824rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12825
12826Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12827driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12828together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12829@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12830you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12831width} commands:
12832
12833@table @code
12834@kindex set height
12835@kindex set width
12836@kindex show width
12837@kindex show height
12838@item set height @var{lpp}
12839@itemx show height
12840@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12841@itemx show width
12842These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12843a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12844commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12845
8e04817f
AC
12846If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12847output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12848file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12849
8e04817f
AC
12850Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12851from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12852@end table
12853
8e04817f
AC
12854@node Numbers
12855@section Numbers
12856@cindex number representation
12857@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12858
8e04817f
AC
12859You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12860@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12861@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12862begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12863default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12864numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12865change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12866radix} command.
104c1213 12867
8e04817f
AC
12868@table @code
12869@kindex set input-radix
12870@item set input-radix @var{base}
12871Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12872for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12873specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12874example, any of
104c1213 12875
8e04817f
AC
12876@smallexample
12877set radix 012
12878set radix 10.
12879set radix 0xa
12880@end smallexample
104c1213 12881
8e04817f
AC
12882@noindent
12883sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12884leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12885
8e04817f
AC
12886@kindex set output-radix
12887@item set output-radix @var{base}
12888Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12889for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12890specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12891
8e04817f
AC
12892@kindex show input-radix
12893@item show input-radix
12894Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12895
8e04817f
AC
12896@kindex show output-radix
12897@item show output-radix
12898Display the current default base for numeric display.
12899@end table
104c1213 12900
8e04817f
AC
12901@node Messages/Warnings
12902@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12903
8e04817f
AC
12904By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12905running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12906command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12907internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12908
8e04817f
AC
12909Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12910which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12911see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12912
8e04817f
AC
12913@table @code
12914@kindex set verbose
12915@item set verbose on
12916Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12917
8e04817f
AC
12918@item set verbose off
12919Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12920
8e04817f
AC
12921@kindex show verbose
12922@item show verbose
12923Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12924@end table
104c1213 12925
8e04817f
AC
12926By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12927object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12928find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12929symbol files}).
104c1213 12930
8e04817f 12931@table @code
104c1213 12932
8e04817f
AC
12933@kindex set complaints
12934@item set complaints @var{limit}
12935Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12936unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12937@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12938to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12939
8e04817f
AC
12940@kindex show complaints
12941@item show complaints
12942Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12943
8e04817f 12944@end table
104c1213 12945
8e04817f
AC
12946By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12947lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12948you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12949
474c8240 12950@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12951(@value{GDBP}) run
12952The program being debugged has been started already.
12953Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12954@end smallexample
104c1213 12955
8e04817f
AC
12956If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12957commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12958
8e04817f 12959@table @code
104c1213 12960
8e04817f
AC
12961@kindex set confirm
12962@cindex flinching
12963@cindex confirmation
12964@cindex stupid questions
12965@item set confirm off
12966Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12967
8e04817f
AC
12968@item set confirm on
12969Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12970
8e04817f
AC
12971@kindex show confirm
12972@item show confirm
12973Displays state of confirmation requests.
12974
12975@end table
104c1213 12976
8e04817f
AC
12977@node Debugging Output
12978@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12979@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12980@kindex set debug arch
12981@item set debug arch
12982Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12983@kindex show debug arch
12984@item show debug arch
12985Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12986@kindex set debug event
12987@item set debug event
12988Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12989default is off.
12990@kindex show debug event
12991@item show debug event
12992Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12993info.
12994@kindex set debug expression
12995@item set debug expression
12996Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12997default is off.
12998@kindex show debug expression
12999@item show debug expression
13000Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13001debugging info.
13002@kindex set debug overload
13003@item set debug overload
13004Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13005info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13006is off.
13007@kindex show debug overload
13008@item show debug overload
13009Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13010debugging info.
13011@kindex set debug remote
13012@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13013@cindex serial connections, debugging
13014@item set debug remote
13015Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13016the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13017@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13018@kindex show debug remote
13019@item show debug remote
13020Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13021@kindex set debug serial
13022@item set debug serial
13023Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13024default is off.
13025@kindex show debug serial
13026@item show debug serial
13027Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13028info.
13029@kindex set debug target
13030@item set debug target
13031Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13032includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13033default is off.
13034@kindex show debug target
13035@item show debug target
13036Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13037info.
13038@kindex set debug varobj
13039@item set debug varobj
13040Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13041info. The default is off.
13042@kindex show debug varobj
13043@item show debug varobj
13044Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13045debugging info.
13046@end table
104c1213 13047
8e04817f
AC
13048@node Sequences
13049@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 13050
8e04817f
AC
13051Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13052command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13053commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13054files.
104c1213 13055
8e04817f
AC
13056@menu
13057* Define:: User-defined commands
13058* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13059* Command Files:: Command files
13060* Output:: Commands for controlled output
13061@end menu
104c1213 13062
8e04817f
AC
13063@node Define
13064@section User-defined commands
104c1213 13065
8e04817f
AC
13066@cindex user-defined command
13067A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13068which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13069@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13070separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13071via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 13072
8e04817f
AC
13073@smallexample
13074define adder
13075 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13076@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
13077
13078@noindent
8e04817f 13079To execute the command use:
104c1213 13080
8e04817f
AC
13081@smallexample
13082adder 1 2 3
13083@end smallexample
104c1213 13084
8e04817f
AC
13085@noindent
13086This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13087its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13088reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13089functions calls.
104c1213
JM
13090
13091@table @code
104c1213 13092
8e04817f
AC
13093@kindex define
13094@item define @var{commandname}
13095Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13096by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 13097
8e04817f
AC
13098The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13099which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13100commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13101
8e04817f
AC
13102@kindex if
13103@kindex else
13104@item if
13105Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13106It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13107only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13108There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13109by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13110was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13111
8e04817f
AC
13112@kindex while
13113@item while
13114The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13115which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13116execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13117The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13118evaluates to true.
104c1213 13119
8e04817f
AC
13120@kindex document
13121@item document @var{commandname}
13122Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13123accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13124defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13125reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13126After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13127@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 13128
8e04817f
AC
13129You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13130documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13131does not change the documentation.
104c1213 13132
8e04817f
AC
13133@kindex help user-defined
13134@item help user-defined
13135List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13136(if any) for each.
104c1213 13137
8e04817f
AC
13138@kindex show user
13139@item show user
13140@itemx show user @var{commandname}
13141Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13142not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13143definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 13144
20f01a46
DH
13145@kindex show max-user-call-depth
13146@kindex set max-user-call-depth
13147@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
13148@itemx set max-user-call-depth
13149The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13150levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13151infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 13152
104c1213
JM
13153@end table
13154
8e04817f
AC
13155When user-defined commands are executed, the
13156commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13157stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 13158
8e04817f
AC
13159If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13160without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13161commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13162messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 13163
8e04817f
AC
13164@node Hooks
13165@section User-defined command hooks
13166@cindex command hooks
13167@cindex hooks, for commands
13168@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 13169
8e04817f
AC
13170@kindex hook
13171@kindex hook-
13172You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13173command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13174command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13175before that command.
104c1213 13176
8e04817f
AC
13177@cindex hooks, post-command
13178@kindex hookpost
13179@kindex hookpost-
13180A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13181Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13182@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13183that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13184pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 13185
8e04817f
AC
13186It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13187occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 13188
8e04817f
AC
13189@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13190@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 13191
8e04817f
AC
13192@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13193In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13194(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13195execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13196displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 13197
8e04817f
AC
13198For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13199single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13200you could define:
104c1213 13201
474c8240 13202@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13203define hook-stop
13204handle SIGALRM nopass
13205end
104c1213 13206
8e04817f
AC
13207define hook-run
13208handle SIGALRM pass
13209end
104c1213 13210
8e04817f
AC
13211define hook-continue
13212handle SIGLARM pass
13213end
474c8240 13214@end smallexample
104c1213 13215
8e04817f
AC
13216As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13217command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13218you could define:
104c1213 13219
474c8240 13220@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13221define hook-echo
13222echo <<<---
13223end
104c1213 13224
8e04817f
AC
13225define hookpost-echo
13226echo --->>>\n
13227end
104c1213 13228
8e04817f
AC
13229(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13230<<<---Hello World--->>>
13231(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 13232
474c8240 13233@end smallexample
104c1213 13234
8e04817f
AC
13235You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13236not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13237name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13238@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13239@c or not?
13240If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13241@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13242(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 13243
8e04817f
AC
13244If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13245get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13246
8e04817f
AC
13247@node Command Files
13248@section Command files
c906108c 13249
8e04817f
AC
13250@cindex command files
13251A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13252commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13253An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13254the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13255
8e04817f
AC
13256@cindex init file
13257@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13258@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13259When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13260@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13261port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13262limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13263During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13264
8e04817f
AC
13265@enumerate
13266@item
13267Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13268DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13269@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13270
8e04817f
AC
13271@item
13272Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13273
8e04817f
AC
13274@item
13275Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13276
8e04817f
AC
13277@item
13278Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13279@end enumerate
c906108c 13280
8e04817f
AC
13281The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13282complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13283and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13284option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13285
8e04817f
AC
13286@cindex init file name
13287On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13288different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13289form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13290different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13291environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13292
8e04817f
AC
13293@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13294@itemize @bullet
13295@item
13296VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13297
8e04817f
AC
13298@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13299@item
13300OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13301
8e04817f
AC
13302@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13303@item
13304ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13305@end itemize
c906108c 13306
8e04817f
AC
13307You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13308@code{source} command:
c906108c 13309
8e04817f
AC
13310@table @code
13311@kindex source
13312@item source @var{filename}
13313Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13314@end table
13315
8e04817f 13316The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13317printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13318execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13319
8e04817f
AC
13320Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13321without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13322normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13323when called from command files.
c906108c 13324
8e04817f
AC
13325@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13326mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13327standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13328not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13329the next command.
c906108c 13330
474c8240 13331@smallexample
8e04817f 13332gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13333@end smallexample
c906108c 13334
8e04817f
AC
13335(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13336will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13337would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13338
8e04817f
AC
13339@node Output
13340@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13341
8e04817f
AC
13342During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13343@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13344explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13345describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13346want.
c906108c
SS
13347
13348@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13349@kindex echo
13350@item echo @var{text}
13351@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13352@c because it is not in ANSI.
13353Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13354@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13355newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13356In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13357by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13358string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13359trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13360To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13361@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13362
8e04817f
AC
13363A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13364the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13365
474c8240 13366@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13367echo This is some text\n\
13368which is continued\n\
13369onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13370@end smallexample
c906108c 13371
8e04817f 13372produces the same output as
c906108c 13373
474c8240 13374@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13375echo This is some text\n
13376echo which is continued\n
13377echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13378@end smallexample
c906108c 13379
8e04817f
AC
13380@kindex output
13381@item output @var{expression}
13382Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13383newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13384value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13385on expressions.
c906108c 13386
8e04817f
AC
13387@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13388Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13389the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13390formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13391
8e04817f
AC
13392@kindex printf
13393@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13394Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13395@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13396either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13397@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13398subroutine
13399@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13400@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13401@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13402@c supported.
c906108c 13403
474c8240 13404@smallexample
8e04817f 13405printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13406@end smallexample
c906108c 13407
8e04817f 13408For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13409
8e04817f
AC
13410@smallexample
13411printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13412@end smallexample
c906108c 13413
8e04817f
AC
13414The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13415string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13416letter.
c906108c
SS
13417@end table
13418
8e04817f
AC
13419@node TUI
13420@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13421@cindex TUI
c906108c 13422
8e04817f
AC
13423@menu
13424* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13425* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13426* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13427* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13428* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13429@end menu
c906108c 13430
8e04817f
AC
13431The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13432is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13433to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13434and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13435The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13436with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13437
8e04817f
AC
13438@node TUI Overview
13439@section TUI overview
c906108c 13440
8e04817f
AC
13441The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13442@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13443
8e04817f
AC
13444@itemize @bullet
13445@item
13446A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13447windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13448
8e04817f
AC
13449@item
13450A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13451the TUI.
13452@end itemize
c906108c 13453
8e04817f
AC
13454In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13455on the terminal:
c906108c 13456
8e04817f
AC
13457@table @emph
13458@item command
13459This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13460prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13461managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13462window is always visible.
c906108c 13463
8e04817f
AC
13464@item source
13465The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13466line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13467
8e04817f
AC
13468@item assembly
13469The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13470
8e04817f
AC
13471@item register
13472This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13473a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13474changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13475
c906108c
SS
13476@end table
13477
269c21fe
SC
13478The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13479by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13480Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13481indicates the breakpoint type:
13482
13483@table @code
13484@item B
13485Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13486
13487@item b
13488Breakpoint which was never hit.
13489
13490@item H
13491Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13492
13493@item h
13494Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13495
13496@end table
13497
13498The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13499
13500@table @code
13501@item +
13502Breakpoint is enabled.
13503
13504@item -
13505Breakpoint is disabled.
13506
13507@end table
13508
8e04817f
AC
13509The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13510and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13511changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13512These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13513layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13514The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13515
8e04817f
AC
13516@itemize @bullet
13517@item
13518source
2df3850c 13519
8e04817f
AC
13520@item
13521assembly
13522
13523@item
13524source and assembly
13525
13526@item
13527source and registers
c906108c 13528
8e04817f
AC
13529@item
13530assembly and registers
2df3850c 13531
8e04817f 13532@end itemize
c906108c 13533
b7bb15bc
SC
13534On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13535concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13536updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13537are displayed:
13538
13539@table @emph
13540@item target
13541Indicates the current gdb target
13542(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13543
13544@item process
13545Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13546When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13547
13548@item function
13549Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13550The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13551When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13552the string @code{??} is displayed.
13553
13554@item line
13555Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13556When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13557
13558@item pc
13559Indicates the current program counter address.
13560
13561@end table
13562
8e04817f
AC
13563@node TUI Keys
13564@section TUI Key Bindings
13565@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13566
8e04817f
AC
13567The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13568(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13569They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13570directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13571a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13572@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13573are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13574
8e04817f
AC
13575@table @kbd
13576@kindex C-x C-a
13577@item C-x C-a
13578@kindex C-x a
13579@itemx C-x a
13580@kindex C-x A
13581@itemx C-x A
13582Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13583the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13584its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13585mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13586The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13587
8e04817f
AC
13588@kindex C-x 1
13589@item C-x 1
13590Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13591either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13592is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13593
8e04817f 13594Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13595
8e04817f
AC
13596@kindex C-x 2
13597@item C-x 2
13598Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13599layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13600When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13601previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13602
8e04817f 13603Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13604
7cf36c78
SC
13605@kindex C-x s
13606@item C-x s
13607Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13608(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13609
c906108c
SS
13610@end table
13611
8e04817f 13612The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13613
8e04817f
AC
13614@table @key
13615@kindex PgUp
13616@item PgUp
13617Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13618
8e04817f
AC
13619@kindex PgDn
13620@item PgDn
13621Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13622
8e04817f
AC
13623@kindex Up
13624@item Up
13625Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13626
8e04817f
AC
13627@kindex Down
13628@item Down
13629Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13630
8e04817f
AC
13631@kindex Left
13632@item Left
13633Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13634
8e04817f
AC
13635@kindex Right
13636@item Right
13637Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13638
8e04817f
AC
13639@kindex C-L
13640@item C-L
13641Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13642
8e04817f 13643@end table
c906108c 13644
8e04817f
AC
13645In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13646for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13647necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13648@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13649
7cf36c78
SC
13650@node TUI Single Key Mode
13651@section TUI Single Key Mode
13652@cindex TUI single key mode
13653
13654The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13655key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13656some gdb commands.
13657
13658@table @kbd
13659@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13660@item c
13661continue
13662
13663@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13664@item d
13665down
13666
13667@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13668@item f
13669finish
13670
13671@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13672@item n
13673next
13674
13675@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13676@item q
13677exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13678
13679@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13680@item r
13681run
13682
13683@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13684@item s
13685step
13686
13687@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13688@item u
13689up
13690
13691@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13692@item v
13693info locals
13694
13695@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13696@item w
13697where
13698
13699@end table
13700
13701Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13702The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13703it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13704with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13705@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13706this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13707
13708
8e04817f
AC
13709@node TUI Commands
13710@section TUI specific commands
13711@cindex TUI commands
13712
13713The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13714These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13715the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13716is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13717in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13718
13719@table @code
3d757584
SC
13720@item info win
13721@kindex info win
13722List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13723
8e04817f
AC
13724@item layout next
13725@kindex layout next
13726Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13727
8e04817f
AC
13728@item layout prev
13729@kindex layout prev
13730Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13731
8e04817f
AC
13732@item layout src
13733@kindex layout src
13734Display the source window only.
c906108c 13735
8e04817f
AC
13736@item layout asm
13737@kindex layout asm
13738Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13739
8e04817f
AC
13740@item layout split
13741@kindex layout split
13742Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13743
8e04817f
AC
13744@item layout regs
13745@kindex layout regs
13746Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13747
13748@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13749@kindex focus
13750Set the focus to the named window.
13751This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13752can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13753
8e04817f
AC
13754@item refresh
13755@kindex refresh
13756Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13757
8e04817f
AC
13758@item update
13759@kindex update
13760Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13761
8e04817f
AC
13762@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13763@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13764@kindex winheight
13765Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13766lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13767decrease it.
2df3850c 13768
c906108c
SS
13769@end table
13770
8e04817f
AC
13771@node TUI Configuration
13772@section TUI configuration variables
13773@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13774
8e04817f
AC
13775The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13776appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13777
8e04817f
AC
13778@table @code
13779@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13780@kindex set tui border-kind
13781Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13782The possible values are the following:
13783@table @code
13784@item space
13785Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13786
8e04817f
AC
13787@item ascii
13788Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13789
8e04817f
AC
13790@item acs
13791Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13792drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13793
8e04817f 13794@end table
c78b4128 13795
8e04817f
AC
13796@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13797@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13798Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13799The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13800@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13801
8e04817f
AC
13802@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13803@kindex set tui border-mode
13804Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13805The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13806@table @code
13807@item normal
13808Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13809
8e04817f
AC
13810@item standout
13811Use standout mode.
c906108c 13812
8e04817f
AC
13813@item reverse
13814Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13815
8e04817f
AC
13816@item half
13817Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13818
8e04817f
AC
13819@item half-standout
13820Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13821
8e04817f
AC
13822@item bold
13823Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13824
8e04817f
AC
13825@item bold-standout
13826Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13827
8e04817f 13828@end table
c78b4128 13829
8e04817f 13830@end table
c78b4128 13831
8e04817f
AC
13832@node Emacs
13833@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13834
8e04817f
AC
13835@cindex Emacs
13836@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13837A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13838edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13839@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13840
8e04817f
AC
13841To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13842executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13843@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13844created Emacs buffer.
13845@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13846
8e04817f
AC
13847Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13848things:
c906108c 13849
8e04817f
AC
13850@itemize @bullet
13851@item
13852All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13853@end itemize
c906108c 13854
8e04817f
AC
13855This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13856and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13857
8e04817f
AC
13858This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13859commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13860in this way.
bf0184be 13861
8e04817f
AC
13862All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13863with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13864way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13865stop.
bf0184be 13866
8e04817f 13867@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13868@item
8e04817f
AC
13869@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13870@end itemize
bf0184be 13871
8e04817f
AC
13872Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13873source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13874left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13875source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13876and the source.
bf0184be 13877
8e04817f
AC
13878Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13879usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13880
8e04817f
AC
13881@quotation
13882@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13883current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13884the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13885appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13886environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13887session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13888back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13889avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13890your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13891@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13892
8e04817f
AC
13893A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13894switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13895@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13896@end quotation
13897
13898By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13899you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13900several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13901Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13902
474c8240 13903@smallexample
8e04817f 13904(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13905@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13906
13907@noindent
13908(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13909in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13910``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13911
13912In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13913addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13914
8e04817f
AC
13915@table @kbd
13916@item C-h m
13917Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13918
8e04817f
AC
13919@item M-s
13920Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13921update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13922
8e04817f
AC
13923@item M-n
13924Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13925calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13926to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13927
8e04817f
AC
13928@item M-i
13929Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13930display window accordingly.
c906108c 13931
8e04817f
AC
13932@item M-x gdb-nexti
13933Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13934display window accordingly.
c906108c 13935
8e04817f
AC
13936@item C-c C-f
13937Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13938@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13939
8e04817f
AC
13940@item M-c
13941Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13942command.
b433d00b 13943
8e04817f 13944@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13945
8e04817f
AC
13946@item M-u
13947Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13948(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13949like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13950
8e04817f 13951@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13952
8e04817f
AC
13953@item M-d
13954Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13955@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13956
8e04817f 13957@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13958
8e04817f
AC
13959@item C-x &
13960Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13961of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13962around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13963then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13964argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13965
8e04817f
AC
13966You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13967@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13968otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13969inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13970wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13971list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13972formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13973is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13974@end table
c906108c 13975
8e04817f
AC
13976In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13977tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13978
8e04817f
AC
13979If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13980it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13981request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13982the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13983frame.
c906108c 13984
8e04817f
AC
13985The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13986which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13987the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13988communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13989delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13990to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13991
8e04817f
AC
13992@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13993@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13994@ignore
13995@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13996@kindex Epoch
13997@kindex inspect
c906108c 13998
8e04817f
AC
13999Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14000called the @code{epoch}
14001environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14002@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14003each value is printed in its own window.
14004@end ignore
c906108c 14005
8e04817f
AC
14006@include annotate.texi
14007@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 14008
8e04817f
AC
14009@node GDB Bugs
14010@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
14011@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
14012@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 14013
8e04817f 14014Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 14015
8e04817f
AC
14016Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
14017may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
14018the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
14019reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14020
8e04817f
AC
14021In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
14022information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
14023
14024@menu
8e04817f
AC
14025* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
14026* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
14027@end menu
14028
8e04817f
AC
14029@node Bug Criteria
14030@section Have you found a bug?
14031@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 14032
8e04817f 14033If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
14034
14035@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
14036@cindex fatal signal
14037@cindex debugger crash
14038@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 14039@item
8e04817f
AC
14040If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
14041@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
14042
14043@cindex error on valid input
14044@item
14045If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
14046bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
14047somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 14048
8e04817f 14049@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 14050@item
8e04817f
AC
14051If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
14052that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
14053``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
14054for traditional practice''.
14055
14056@item
14057If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
14058for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
14059@end itemize
14060
8e04817f
AC
14061@node Bug Reporting
14062@section How to report bugs
14063@cindex bug reports
14064@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
14065
14066A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
14067If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
14068contact that organization first.
14069
14070You can find contact information for many support companies and
14071individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
14072distribution.
14073@c should add a web page ref...
14074
129188f6
AC
14075In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
14076@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
14077@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
14078page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
14079be used.
8e04817f
AC
14080
14081@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
14082@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
14083not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
14084@samp{bug-gdb}.
14085
14086The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
14087serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
14088the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
14089newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
14090problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
14091path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
14092we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
14093bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 14094
8e04817f
AC
14095The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
14096@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
14097fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 14098
8e04817f
AC
14099Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
14100problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
14101assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
14102Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
14103stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
14104name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
14105of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
14106the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
14107easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 14108
8e04817f
AC
14109Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
14110bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
14111you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
14112self-contained.
c4555f82 14113
8e04817f
AC
14114Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
14115bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
14116@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
14117bugs properly.
14118
14119To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
14120
14121@itemize @bullet
14122@item
8e04817f
AC
14123The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
14124with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
14125version}.
c4555f82 14126
8e04817f
AC
14127Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
14128the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
14129
14130@item
8e04817f
AC
14131The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
14132version number.
c4555f82
SC
14133
14134@item
8e04817f
AC
14135What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
14136``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
14137
14138@item
8e04817f
AC
14139What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
14140debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
14141C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
14142information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
14143compilers.
c4555f82 14144
8e04817f
AC
14145@item
14146The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
14147observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
14148you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
14149Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 14150
8e04817f
AC
14151If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
14152and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 14153
8e04817f
AC
14154@item
14155A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
14156reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 14157
8e04817f
AC
14158@item
14159A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
14160incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 14161
8e04817f
AC
14162Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
14163will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
14164not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
14165a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 14166
8e04817f
AC
14167Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
14168say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
14169copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
14170the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
14171crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
14172ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
14173us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
14174to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 14175
8e04817f
AC
14176@item
14177If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
14178diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
14179it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 14180
8e04817f
AC
14181The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
14182sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 14183
8e04817f 14184@end itemize
c4555f82 14185
8e04817f 14186Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 14187
8e04817f
AC
14188@itemize @bullet
14189@item
14190A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 14191
8e04817f
AC
14192Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
14193which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
14194changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 14195
8e04817f
AC
14196This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
14197will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
14198with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
14199We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 14200
8e04817f
AC
14201Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
14202of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
14203output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
14204less time, and so on.
c4555f82 14205
8e04817f
AC
14206However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
14207report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 14208
8e04817f
AC
14209@item
14210A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 14211
8e04817f
AC
14212A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
14213the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
14214a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
14215to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 14216
8e04817f
AC
14217Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
14218construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
14219through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
14220to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 14221
8e04817f
AC
14222And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
14223patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
14224help us to understand.
c4555f82 14225
8e04817f
AC
14226@item
14227A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 14228
8e04817f
AC
14229Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
14230things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
14231@end itemize
c4555f82 14232
8e04817f
AC
14233@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
14234@c and consists of the two following files:
14235@c rluser.texinfo
14236@c inc-hist.texinfo
14237@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
14238@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
14239@include rluser.texinfo
14240@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 14241
c4555f82 14242
8e04817f
AC
14243@node Formatting Documentation
14244@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 14245
8e04817f
AC
14246@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14247@cindex reference card
14248The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14249for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14250subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14251@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14252release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14253you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 14254
8e04817f
AC
14255The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14256can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 14257
474c8240 14258@smallexample
8e04817f 14259make refcard.dvi
474c8240 14260@end smallexample
c4555f82 14261
8e04817f
AC
14262The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14263mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14264that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14265high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14266your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 14267
8e04817f 14268@cindex documentation
c4555f82 14269
8e04817f
AC
14270All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14271distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14272a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14273on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14274formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14275and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 14276
8e04817f
AC
14277@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14278version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14279file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14280subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14281necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14282but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14283Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14284@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 14285
8e04817f
AC
14286If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14287Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14288@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 14289
8e04817f
AC
14290If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14291@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14292version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 14293
474c8240 14294@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14295cd gdb
14296make gdb.info
474c8240 14297@end smallexample
c4555f82 14298
8e04817f
AC
14299If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14300a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14301Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 14302
8e04817f
AC
14303@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14304produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14305document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14306has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14307command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14308(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14309require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 14310
8e04817f
AC
14311@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14312@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14313written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14314typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14315and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14316directory.
c4555f82 14317
8e04817f
AC
14318If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14319typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14320subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14321@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14322
474c8240 14323@smallexample
8e04817f 14324make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14325@end smallexample
c4555f82 14326
8e04817f 14327Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14328
8e04817f
AC
14329@node Installing GDB
14330@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14331@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14332@cindex installation
c4555f82 14333
8e04817f
AC
14334@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14335of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14336build the @code{gdb} program.
14337@iftex
14338@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14339@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14340look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14341installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14342@end iftex
c4555f82 14343
8e04817f
AC
14344The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14345@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14346appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14347
8e04817f
AC
14348For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14349@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14350
8e04817f
AC
14351@table @code
14352@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14353script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14354
8e04817f
AC
14355@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14356the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14357
8e04817f
AC
14358@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14359source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14360
8e04817f
AC
14361@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14362@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14363
8e04817f
AC
14364@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14365source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14366
8e04817f
AC
14367@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14368source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14369
8e04817f
AC
14370@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14371source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14372
8e04817f
AC
14373@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14374source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14375
8e04817f
AC
14376@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14377source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14378@end table
c906108c 14379
8e04817f
AC
14380The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14381from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14382this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14383
8e04817f
AC
14384First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14385if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14386identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14387argument.
c906108c 14388
8e04817f 14389For example:
c906108c 14390
474c8240 14391@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14392cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14393./configure @var{host}
14394make
474c8240 14395@end smallexample
c906108c 14396
8e04817f
AC
14397@noindent
14398where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14399@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14400(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14401correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14402
8e04817f
AC
14403Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14404@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14405libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14406binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14407
8e04817f
AC
14408@need 750
14409@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14410system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14411shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14412
474c8240 14413@smallexample
8e04817f 14414sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14415@end smallexample
c906108c 14416
8e04817f
AC
14417If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14418directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14419@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14420creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14421you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14422
14423You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14424subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14425configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 14426
8e04817f
AC
14427For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14428the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 14429
474c8240 14430@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14431@group
14432cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14433../configure @var{host}
14434@end group
474c8240 14435@end smallexample
c906108c 14436
8e04817f
AC
14437You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14438However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14439the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14440that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14441let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14442
8e04817f
AC
14443@menu
14444* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14445* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14446* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14447@end menu
c906108c 14448
8e04817f
AC
14449@node Separate Objdir
14450@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14451
8e04817f
AC
14452If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14453you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14454host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14455allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14456rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14457handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14458@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14459program specified there.
c906108c 14460
8e04817f
AC
14461To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14462with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14463(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14464itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14465would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14466the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14467
8e04817f
AC
14468For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14469separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14470
474c8240 14471@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14472@group
14473cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14474mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14475cd ../gdb-sun4
14476../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14477make
14478@end group
474c8240 14479@end smallexample
c906108c 14480
8e04817f
AC
14481When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14482directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14483(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14484the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14485directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14486@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14487
8e04817f
AC
14488One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14489directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14490@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14491programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14492You specify a cross-debugging target by
14493giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14494
8e04817f
AC
14495When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14496it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14497called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14498
8e04817f
AC
14499The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14500directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14501directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14502directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14503will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14504
8e04817f
AC
14505When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14506directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14507if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14508with each other.
c906108c 14509
8e04817f
AC
14510@node Config Names
14511@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14512
8e04817f
AC
14513The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14514script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14515aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14516of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14517
474c8240 14518@smallexample
8e04817f 14519@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14520@end smallexample
c906108c 14521
8e04817f
AC
14522For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14523or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14524option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14525
8e04817f
AC
14526The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14527any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14528aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14529@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14530script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14531abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14532
8e04817f
AC
14533@smallexample
14534% sh config.sub i386-linux
14535i386-pc-linux-gnu
14536% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14537alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14538% sh config.sub hp9k700
14539hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14540% sh config.sub sun4
14541sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14542% sh config.sub sun3
14543m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14544% sh config.sub i986v
14545Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14546@end smallexample
c906108c 14547
8e04817f
AC
14548@noindent
14549@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14550directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14551
8e04817f
AC
14552@node Configure Options
14553@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14554
8e04817f
AC
14555Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14556are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14557several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14558Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14559
474c8240 14560@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14561configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14562 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14563 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14564 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14565 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14566 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14567 @var{host}
474c8240 14568@end smallexample
c906108c 14569
8e04817f
AC
14570@noindent
14571You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14572@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14573@samp{--}.
c906108c 14574
8e04817f
AC
14575@table @code
14576@item --help
14577Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14578
8e04817f
AC
14579@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14580Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14581@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14582
8e04817f
AC
14583@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14584Configure the source to install programs under directory
14585@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14586
8e04817f
AC
14587@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14588@need 2000
14589@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14590@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14591@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14592Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14593@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14594build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14595directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14596the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14597directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14598the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14599@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14600
8e04817f
AC
14601@item --norecursion
14602Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14603propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14604
8e04817f
AC
14605@item --target=@var{target}
14606Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14607@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14608programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14609
8e04817f 14610There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14611
8e04817f
AC
14612@item @var{host} @dots{}
14613Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14614
8e04817f
AC
14615There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14616@end table
c906108c 14617
8e04817f
AC
14618There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14619needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14620
8e04817f
AC
14621@node Maintenance Commands
14622@appendix Maintenance Commands
14623@cindex maintenance commands
14624@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14625
8e04817f
AC
14626In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14627includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14628These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14629
8e04817f
AC
14630@table @code
14631@kindex maint info breakpoints
14632@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14633Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14634breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14635internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14636breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14637is shown:
c906108c 14638
8e04817f
AC
14639@table @code
14640@item breakpoint
14641Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14642
8e04817f
AC
14643@item watchpoint
14644Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14645
8e04817f
AC
14646@item longjmp
14647Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14648@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14649
8e04817f
AC
14650@item longjmp resume
14651Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14652
8e04817f
AC
14653@item until
14654Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14655
8e04817f
AC
14656@item finish
14657Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14658
8e04817f
AC
14659@item shlib events
14660Shared library events.
c906108c 14661
8e04817f 14662@end table
c906108c 14663
8d30a00d
AC
14664@kindex maint internal-error
14665@kindex maint internal-warning
14666@item maint internal-error
14667@itemx maint internal-warning
14668Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14669or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14670or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14671internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14672either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14673@value{GDBN} session.
14674
14675@smallexample
14676(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14677@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14678A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14679debugging may prove unreliable.
14680Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14681Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14682(gdb)
14683@end smallexample
14684
14685Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14686warning message.
14687
0680b120
AC
14688@kindex maint print registers
14689@kindex maint print raw-registers
14690@kindex maint print cooked-registers
14691@item maint print registers
14692@itemx maint print raw-registers
14693@itemx maint print cooked-registers
14694Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14695
14696The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14697the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14698cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14699@xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14700
14701Takes an optional file parameter.
14702
8e04817f 14703@end table
c906108c 14704
c906108c 14705
e0ce93ac 14706@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14707@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14708
ee2d5c50
AC
14709@menu
14710* Overview::
14711* Packets::
14712* Stop Reply Packets::
14713* General Query Packets::
14714* Register Packet Format::
14715* Examples::
14716@end menu
14717
14718@node Overview
14719@section Overview
14720
8e04817f
AC
14721There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14722protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14723machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14724recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14725
d2c6833e 14726In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14727transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14728
8e04817f
AC
14729@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14730@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14731@cindex remote serial protocol
14732All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14733sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14734@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14735@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14736
474c8240 14737@smallexample
8e04817f 14738@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14739@end smallexample
8e04817f 14740@noindent
c906108c 14741
8e04817f
AC
14742@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14743@noindent
14744The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14745characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14746eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14747
8e04817f
AC
14748Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14749specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14750
474c8240 14751@smallexample
8e04817f 14752@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14753@end smallexample
c906108c 14754
8e04817f
AC
14755@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14756@noindent
14757That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14758has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14759since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14760
8e04817f
AC
14761@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14762When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14763response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14764the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14765retransmission):
c906108c 14766
474c8240 14767@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14768-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14769<- @code{+}
474c8240 14770@end smallexample
8e04817f 14771@noindent
53a5351d 14772
8e04817f
AC
14773The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14774debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14775the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14776when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14777
8e04817f
AC
14778@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14779exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14780exceptions).
c906108c 14781
8e04817f 14782Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14783@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14784@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14785@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14786
8e04817f
AC
14787Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14788@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14789would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14790
8e04817f
AC
14791Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14792means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14793which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14794@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14795where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14796characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14797value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14798
8e04817f
AC
14799Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14800loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14801character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14802
8e04817f 14803So:
474c8240 14804@smallexample
8e04817f 14805"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14806@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14807@noindent
14808means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14809
8e04817f
AC
14810The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14811error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14812
8e04817f
AC
14813For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14814(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14815protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14816on that response.
c906108c 14817
8e04817f
AC
14818A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14819@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14820optional.
c906108c 14821
ee2d5c50
AC
14822@node Packets
14823@section Packets
14824
14825The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14826@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14827
14828@table @r
14829
14830@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14831@cindex @code{!} packet
14832
8e04817f
AC
14833Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14834persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14835debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14836
14837Reply:
14838@table @samp
14839@item OK
8e04817f 14840The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14841@end table
c906108c 14842
ee2d5c50
AC
14843@item @code{?} --- last signal
14844@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14845
ee2d5c50
AC
14846Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14847step and continue.
c906108c 14848
ee2d5c50
AC
14849Reply:
14850@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14851
14852@item @code{a} --- reserved
14853
14854Reserved for future use.
14855
14856@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14857@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14858
8e04817f
AC
14859Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14860specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14861See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14862
14863Reply:
14864@table @samp
14865@item OK
14866@item E@var{NN}
14867@end table
14868
14869@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14870@cindex @code{b} packet
14871
14872Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14873
14874JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14875received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14876problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14877
14878Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14879it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14880some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14881switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14882of view, nothing actually happened.}
14883
14884@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14885@cindex @code{B} packet
14886
8e04817f 14887Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14888breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14889
14890This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14891(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14892
ee2d5c50
AC
14893@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14894@cindex @code{c} packet
14895
14896@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14897current address.
c906108c 14898
ee2d5c50
AC
14899Reply:
14900@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14901
14902@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14903@cindex @code{C} packet
14904
8e04817f
AC
14905Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14906@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14907
ee2d5c50
AC
14908Reply:
14909@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14910
ee2d5c50
AC
14911@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14912@cindex @code{d} packet
14913
14914Toggle debug flag.
14915
14916@item @code{D} --- detach
14917@cindex @code{D} packet
14918
14919Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14920before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14921
14922Reply:
14923@table @samp
14924@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14925@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14926@end table
c906108c 14927
ee2d5c50 14928@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14929
ee2d5c50 14930Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14931
ee2d5c50 14932@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14933
ee2d5c50 14934Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14935
ee2d5c50
AC
14936@item @code{f} --- reserved
14937
14938Reserved for future use.
14939
14940@item @code{F} --- reserved
14941
14942Reserved for future use.
14943
14944@item @code{g} --- read registers
14945@anchor{read registers packet}
14946@cindex @code{g} packet
14947
14948Read general registers.
14949
14950Reply:
14951@table @samp
14952@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14953Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14954with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14955each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14956determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14957and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14958@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14959@item E@var{NN}
14960for an error.
14961@end table
c906108c 14962
ee2d5c50
AC
14963@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14964@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14965
ee2d5c50
AC
14966@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14967data.
14968
14969Reply:
14970@table @samp
14971@item OK
14972for success
14973@item E@var{NN}
14974for an error
14975@end table
14976
14977@item @code{h} --- reserved
14978
14979Reserved for future use.
14980
14981@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14982@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14983
8e04817f 14984Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14985@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14986should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14987operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14988the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14989
14990Reply:
14991@table @samp
14992@item OK
14993for success
14994@item E@var{NN}
14995for an error
14996@end table
c906108c 14997
8e04817f
AC
14998@c FIXME: JTC:
14999@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
15000@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
15001@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
15002@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
15003@c described. For example:
15004@c
15005@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
15006@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
15007@c otherwise returns current registers.
15008@c
15009@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
15010@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
15011@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 15012
ee2d5c50
AC
15013@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
15014@anchor{cycle step packet}
15015@cindex @code{i} packet
15016
8e04817f
AC
15017Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
15018present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
15019step starting at that address.
c906108c 15020
ee2d5c50
AC
15021@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
15022@cindex @code{I} packet
15023
15024@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
15025
15026@item @code{j} --- reserved
15027
15028Reserved for future use.
15029
15030@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 15031
ee2d5c50 15032Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15033
ee2d5c50
AC
15034@item @code{k} --- kill request
15035@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 15036
ac282366 15037FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
15038thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
15039thread?)}.
c906108c 15040
ee2d5c50 15041@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 15042
ee2d5c50
AC
15043Reserved for future use.
15044
15045@item @code{l} --- reserved
15046
15047Reserved for future use.
15048
15049@item @code{L} --- reserved
15050
15051Reserved for future use.
15052
15053@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
15054@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 15055
8e04817f 15056Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15057Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
15058assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 15059transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 15060
ee2d5c50
AC
15061Reply:
15062@table @samp
15063@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15064@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
15065to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
15066that sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned
15067accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
15068needed.}
15069@item E@var{NN}
15070@var{NN} is errno
15071@end table
15072
15073@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
15074@cindex @code{M} packet
15075
8e04817f 15076Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15077@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
15078
15079Reply:
15080@table @samp
15081@item OK
15082for success
15083@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
15084for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
15085written).
ee2d5c50 15086@end table
c906108c 15087
ee2d5c50 15088@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 15089
ee2d5c50 15090Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15091
ee2d5c50 15092@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 15093
ee2d5c50 15094Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15095
ee2d5c50
AC
15096@item @code{o} --- reserved
15097
15098Reserved for future use.
15099
15100@item @code{O} --- reserved
15101
15102Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15103
ee2d5c50
AC
15104@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
15105@cindex @code{p} packet
15106
15107@xref{write register packet}.
15108
15109Reply:
15110@table @samp
15111@item @var{r@dots{}.}
15112The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
15113@end table
15114
15115@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
15116@anchor{write register packet}
15117@cindex @code{P} packet
15118
15119Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 15120digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 15121
ee2d5c50
AC
15122Reply:
15123@table @samp
15124@item OK
15125for success
15126@item E@var{NN}
15127for an error
15128@end table
15129
15130@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
15131@anchor{general query packet}
15132@cindex @code{q} packet
15133
15134Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
15135leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
15136prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
15137be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
15138that they match the full @var{query} name.
15139
15140Reply:
15141@table @samp
15142@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15143Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
15144@item E@var{NN}
15145error reply
8e04817f 15146@item
ee2d5c50
AC
15147Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
15148@end table
15149
15150@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
15151@cindex @code{Q} packet
15152
15153Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
15154
15155@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 15156
ee2d5c50
AC
15157@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
15158@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 15159
8e04817f 15160Reset the entire system.
c906108c 15161
ee2d5c50
AC
15162@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
15163@cindex @code{R} packet
15164
8e04817f
AC
15165Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
15166This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
15167
15168Reply:
15169@table @samp
15170@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 15171The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
15172@end table
15173
15174@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
15175@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 15176
8e04817f
AC
15177@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
15178same address.
c906108c 15179
ee2d5c50
AC
15180Reply:
15181@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15182
15183@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
15184@anchor{step with signal packet}
15185@cindex @code{S} packet
15186
8e04817f 15187Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 15188
ee2d5c50
AC
15189Reply:
15190@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15191
15192@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
15193@cindex @code{t} packet
15194
8e04817f 15195Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
15196@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
15197@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 15198
ee2d5c50
AC
15199@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
15200@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 15201
ee2d5c50 15202Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 15203
ee2d5c50
AC
15204Reply:
15205@table @samp
15206@item OK
15207thread is still alive
15208@item E@var{NN}
15209thread is dead
15210@end table
15211
15212@item @code{u} --- reserved
15213
15214Reserved for future use.
15215
15216@item @code{U} --- reserved
15217
15218Reserved for future use.
15219
15220@item @code{v} --- reserved
15221
15222Reserved for future use.
15223
15224@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 15225
ee2d5c50 15226Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15227
ee2d5c50 15228@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 15229
ee2d5c50 15230Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15231
ee2d5c50 15232@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 15233
ee2d5c50 15234Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15235
ee2d5c50
AC
15236@item @code{x} --- reserved
15237
15238Reserved for future use.
15239
15240@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
15241@cindex @code{X} packet
15242
15243@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
15244is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 15245escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 15246
ee2d5c50
AC
15247Reply:
15248@table @samp
15249@item OK
15250for success
15251@item E@var{NN}
15252for an error
15253@end table
15254
15255@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 15256
ee2d5c50 15257Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15258
ee2d5c50
AC
15259@item @code{Y} reserved
15260
15261Reserved for future use.
15262
2f870471
AC
15263@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15264@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15265@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 15266@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 15267@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 15268
2f870471
AC
15269Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15270watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15271@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 15272
2f870471
AC
15273Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15274separately.
15275
15276@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return @samp{} for an
15277unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A remote
15278target shall support either both or neither of a given
15279@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15280avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15281be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15282
15283@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15284@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15285@cindex @code{z0} packet
15286@cindex @code{Z0} packet
15287
15288Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15289@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15290
15291A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15292@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15293@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15294breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15295@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 15296
2f870471
AC
15297@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15298code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15299overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15300target, is not defined.}
c906108c 15301
ee2d5c50
AC
15302Reply:
15303@table @samp
2f870471
AC
15304@item OK
15305success
15306@item
15307not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
15308@item E@var{NN}
15309for an error
2f870471
AC
15310@end table
15311
15312@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15313@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15314@cindex @code{z1} packet
15315@cindex @code{Z1} packet
15316
15317Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15318address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15319
15320A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15321dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15322
15323@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15324movement.}
15325
15326Reply:
15327@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15328@item OK
2f870471
AC
15329success
15330@item
15331not supported
15332@item E@var{NN}
15333for an error
15334@end table
15335
15336@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15337@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15338@cindex @code{z2} packet
15339@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15340
15341Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15342
15343Reply:
15344@table @samp
15345@item OK
15346success
15347@item
15348not supported
15349@item E@var{NN}
15350for an error
15351@end table
15352
15353@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15354@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15355@cindex @code{z3} packet
15356@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15357
15358Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a write watchpoint.
15359
15360Reply:
15361@table @samp
15362@item OK
15363success
15364@item
15365not supported
15366@item E@var{NN}
15367for an error
15368@end table
15369
15370@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15371@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15372@cindex @code{z4} packet
15373@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15374
15375Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15376
15377Reply:
15378@table @samp
15379@item OK
15380success
15381@item
15382not supported
15383@item E@var{NN}
15384for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15385@end table
15386
15387@end table
c906108c 15388
ee2d5c50
AC
15389@node Stop Reply Packets
15390@section Stop Reply Packets
15391@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15392
8e04817f
AC
15393The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15394receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15395@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15396when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15397number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15398conventions is used.
c906108c 15399
ee2d5c50 15400@table @samp
c906108c 15401
ee2d5c50
AC
15402@item S@var{AA}
15403@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15404
8e04817f 15405@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15406@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15407
8e04817f
AC
15408@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15409(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15410by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15411thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15412@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15413integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15414@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15415to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15416
ee2d5c50
AC
15417@item W@var{AA}
15418
8e04817f 15419The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15420applicable to certain targets.
15421
15422@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15423
8e04817f 15424The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15425
ee2d5c50
AC
15426@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15427
15428@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15429@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15430base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15431The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15432the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15433is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15434
ee2d5c50 15435@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15436
ee2d5c50
AC
15437@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15438any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15439to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15440
15441@end table
15442
15443@node General Query Packets
15444@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15445
8e04817f 15446The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15447
ee2d5c50 15448@table @r
c906108c 15449
ee2d5c50
AC
15450@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15451
15452Return the current thread id.
15453
15454Reply:
15455@table @samp
15456@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15457Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15458@item *
15459Any other reply implies the old pid.
15460@end table
15461
15462@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15463
15464@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15465
8e04817f
AC
15466Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15467may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15468works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15469obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15470be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15471sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15472
15473NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15474
15475Reply:
15476@table @samp
15477@item @code{m}@var{id}
15478A single thread id
15479@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15480a comma-separated list of thread ids
15481@item @code{l}
15482(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15483@end table
15484
15485In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15486more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15487will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15488@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15489(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15490
ee2d5c50
AC
15491@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15492
15493Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15494string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15495string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15496@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15497in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15498possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15499Mutex''.
15500
15501Reply:
15502@table @samp
15503@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15504Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15505the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15506attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15507@end table
15508
15509@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15510
8e04817f
AC
15511Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15512digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15513subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15514number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15515(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15516returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15517
15518NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15519(see above).
15520
15521Reply:
15522@table @samp
15523@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15524Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15525returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15526and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15527digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15528is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15529digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15530@end table
c906108c 15531
ee2d5c50
AC
15532@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15533
15534Reply:
15535@table @samp
15536@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15537An error (such as memory fault)
15538@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15539A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15540@end table
15541
15542@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15543
8e04817f
AC
15544Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15545image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15546response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15547offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15548
ee2d5c50
AC
15549Reply:
15550@table @samp
15551@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15552@end table
15553
15554@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15555
8e04817f
AC
15556Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15557encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15558
15559Reply:
15560@table @samp
15561@item *
15562@end table
15563
8e04817f 15564See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15565
ee2d5c50
AC
15566@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15567
15568@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15569execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15570Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15571number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15572@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15573interpreter may have security implications}.
15574
15575Reply:
15576@table @samp
15577@item OK
8e04817f 15578A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15579@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15580A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15581@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15582Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15583@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15584When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15585@end table
15586
15587@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15588
8e04817f
AC
15589Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15590requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15591
15592Reply:
15593@table @samp
15594@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15595The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15596@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15597The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15598@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15599@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15600@end table
15601
15602@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15603
15604Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15605
15606@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15607target has previously requested.
15608
15609@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15610@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15611will be empty.
15612
15613Reply:
15614@table @samp
15615@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15616The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15617@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15618The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15619encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15620(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15621@end table
eb12ee30 15622
ee2d5c50
AC
15623@end table
15624
15625@node Register Packet Format
15626@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15627
8e04817f 15628The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15629In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15630sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15631to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15632byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15633most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15634
ee2d5c50 15635@table @r
eb12ee30 15636
8e04817f 15637@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15638
8e04817f
AC
15639All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1564032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15641registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15642
8e04817f 15643@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15644
8e04817f
AC
15645All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15646thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15647as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15648
ee2d5c50
AC
15649@end table
15650
15651@node Examples
15652@section Examples
eb12ee30 15653
8e04817f
AC
15654Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15655does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15656
474c8240 15657@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15658-> @code{R00}
15659<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15660@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15661-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15662<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15663<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15664-> @code{+}
474c8240 15665@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15666
8e04817f 15667Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15668
474c8240 15669@smallexample
d2c6833e 15670-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15671<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15672-> @code{s}
15673<- @code{+}
15674@emph{time passes}
15675<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15676-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15677-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15678<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15679<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15680-> @code{+}
474c8240 15681@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15682
aab4e0ec 15683@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15684
6826cf00
EZ
15685@include fdl.texi
15686
6d2ebf8b 15687@node Index
c906108c
SS
15688@unnumbered Index
15689
15690@printindex cp
15691
15692@tex
15693% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15694% meantime:
15695\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15696\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15697\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15698\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15699\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15700\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15701\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15702\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15703\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15704\page\colophon
15705% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15706@end tex
15707
c906108c 15708@bye